aboutsummaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja.po6
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/DrakLive-cover.xml76
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/DrakLive.xml65
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/DrakX-cover.xml146
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/DrakX.xml135
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/SelectAndUseISOs2.xml460
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/acceptLicense.xml81
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/addUser.xml161
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/add_supplemental_media.xml55
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/ask_mntpoint_s.xml88
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/bestTime.xml21
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/bootLive.xml135
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/chooseDesktop.xml33
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/choosePackageGroups.xml40
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/choosePackagesTree.xml23
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/configureServices.xml40
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/configureTimezoneUTC.xml29
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/configureX_card_list.xml59
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/configureX_chooser.xml64
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/configureX_monitor.xml83
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/diskdrake.xml67
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/doPartitionDisks.xml141
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/exitInstall.xml38
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/formatPartitions.xml46
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/installUpdates.xml31
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/installer.xml270
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/login.xml24
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/media_selection.xml46
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/minimal-install.xml48
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/misc-params.xml210
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/reboot.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/resizeFATChoose.xml33
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/securityLevel.xml32
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/selectCountry.xml63
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/selectInstallClass.xml74
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboard.xml56
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboardLive.xml14
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/selectLanguage.xml63
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/selectMouse.xml31
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/setupBootloader.xml114
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml64
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/setupSCSI.xml45
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/soundConfig.xml52
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/takeOverHdConfirm.xml33
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/testing.xml80
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/uninstall-Mageia.xml37
-rw-r--r--docs/installer/ja/unused.xml27
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja.po2
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC-cover.xml62
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC.xml46
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/MageiaUpdate.xml46
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/XFdrake.xml129
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--dav.xml81
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--fileshare.xml58
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--nfs.xml88
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--removable.xml52
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--smb.xml89
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drak3d.xml80
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakauth.xml29
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakautologin.xml39
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakboot.xml170
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug_report.xml71
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakclock.xml50
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect--del.xml18
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect.xml808
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconsole.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakdisk.xml82
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakedm.xml27
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfirewall.xml86
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfont.xml65
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakguard.xml100
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakgw.xml123
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakhosts.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakinvictus.xml19
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetcenter.xml220
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetprofile.xml19
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draknfs.xml165
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakproxy.xml37
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakrpm-edit-media.xml211
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draksambashare.xml251
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draksec.xml54
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draksnapshot-config.xml49
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/draksound.xml61
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakups.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakvpn.xml81
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_apache2.xml111
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_bind.xml20
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_dhcp.xml194
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_ntp.xml117
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_proftpd.xml102
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_squid.xml238
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_sshd.xml142
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/drakxservices.xml19
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/harddrake2.xml87
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/keyboarddrake.xml44
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/localedrake.xml55
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/logdrake.xml111
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/lsnetdrake.xml26
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/lspcidrake.xml50
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-boot.xml41
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-hardware.xml101
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-intro.xml23
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-localdisks.xml31
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-network.xml82
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networkservices.xml53
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networksharing.xml44
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-security.xml50
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-sharing.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-system.xml95
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mgaapplet-config.xml34
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/mousedrake.xml26
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/msecgui.xml358
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/otherMageiaTools.xml42
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/rpmdrake.xml251
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/scannerdrake.xml259
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/software-management.xml39
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/system-config-printer.xml341
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/transfugdrake.xml138
-rw-r--r--docs/mcc-help/ja/userdrake.xml154
120 files changed, 10743 insertions, 4 deletions
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja.po b/docs/installer/ja.po
index b0a97e14..0d438588 100644
--- a/docs/installer/ja.po
+++ b/docs/installer/ja.po
@@ -3,14 +3,14 @@
# This file is distributed under the same license as the Mageia Installer Help package.
#
# Translators:
-# taro yamada <riokoko5@gmail.com>, 2016
+# ook rio <riokoko5@gmail.com>, 2016
msgid ""
msgstr ""
"Project-Id-Version: Mageia\n"
"Report-Msgid-Bugs-To: doc-discuss@ml.mageia.org\n"
"POT-Creation-Date: 2016-02-10 16:29+0200\n"
-"PO-Revision-Date: 2016-04-27 07:46+0000\n"
-"Last-Translator: taro yamada <riokoko5@gmail.com>\n"
+"PO-Revision-Date: 2016-04-27 16:17+0000\n"
+"Last-Translator: ook rio <riokoko5@gmail.com>\n"
"Language-Team: Japanese (http://www.transifex.com/MageiaLinux/mageia/"
"language/ja/)\n"
"Language: ja\n"
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/DrakLive-cover.xml b/docs/installer/ja/DrakLive-cover.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5e8e4a05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/DrakLive-cover.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,76 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<book xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="Quick-Startup">
+ <info>
+ <title>Installation from LIVE medium</title>
+ <publisher> <publishername>Mageia.org</publishername> </publisher>
+ <revhistory>
+ <revision>
+ <date>January 2015</date>
+ <revremark>Mageia 5</revremark>
+ </revision>
+ </revhistory>
+ <cover>
+ <para role="tagline">The Official Documentation for Mageia</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="mageia-2013.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+ <para>The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+ <article>
+ <title>Installation from LIVE medium</title>
+ <para><note>
+ <para>No one will see all the installer screens that you see in this manual. Which
+screens you will see, depends on your hardware and the choices you make
+while installing.</para>
+ </note></para>
+ <xi:include href="SelectAndUseISOs2.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="bootLive.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectLanguage.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="acceptLicense.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureTimezoneUTC.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="bestTime.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectKeyboardLive.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="testing.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="doPartitionDisks.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="ask_mntpoint_s.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="takeOverHdConfirm.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="formatPartitions.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="unused.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloader.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="reboot.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="addUser.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="login.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="uninstall-Mageia.xml"/>
+ </article>
+</book> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/DrakLive.xml b/docs/installer/ja/DrakLive.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..923d85a7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/DrakLive.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><article xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="Quick-Startup">
+ <info>
+ <title>Installation from LIVE medium</title>
+
+ <cover>
+ <para><note>
+ <para>No one will see all the installer screens that you see in this manual. Which
+screens you will see, depends on your hardware and the choices you make
+while installing.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para xml:id="CC_BY-SA">The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.</para>
+
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.</para>
+
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+
+ <xi:include href="SelectAndUseISOs2.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="bootLive.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectLanguage.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="acceptLicense.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureTimezoneUTC.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="bestTime.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectKeyboardLive.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="testing.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="doPartitionDisks.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="ask_mntpoint_s.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="takeOverHdConfirm.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="formatPartitions.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="unused.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloader.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="reboot.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="addUser.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="login.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="uninstall-Mageia.xml"/>
+</article> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/DrakX-cover.xml b/docs/installer/ja/DrakX-cover.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..98959136
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/DrakX-cover.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,146 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<!-- Converted by db4-upgrade version 1.0 -->
+<book xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="Quick-Startup">
+ <info>
+ <title>Installation with DrakX</title>
+ <publisher> <publishername>Mageia.org</publishername> </publisher>
+ <revhistory>
+ <revision>
+ <date>February 2014</date>
+ <revremark>Mageia 4</revremark>
+ </revision>
+ </revhistory>
+ <cover>
+ <para role="tagline">The Official Documentation for Mageia</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="mageia-2013.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+ <para>The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+ <article>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<!-- 2013-01-03 removed link to choosePackages.xml, because there is no link to it in installer. link to setupX has been removed for the same reason, before-->
+<!--2013-03-31 removed link to setupBootloaderBeginner.xml, because that page is no longer needed -->
+<!--2013-05-10 hid includes for resizeFATchoose.xml and takeOverHdChoose.xml, because since over a year ago, no one in docteam managed to make a screenshot of those installer screens. They seem to already have been obsoleted in Mandriva -->
+<!--2013-05-10 put ask_mntpoint_s.xml before takeOverHdConfirm.xml, to better reflect the order in which the links to them appear in doPartitionDisks.xml -->
+<!--2013-12-08 add soundConfig.xml -->
+<title>Installation with DrakX</title>
+ <para><note>
+ <para>No one will see all the installer screens that you see in this manual. Which
+screens you will see, depends on your hardware and the choices you make
+while installing.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="drakx-intro.xml"/>
+ -->
+<xi:include href="SelectAndUseISOs2.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="installer.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectLanguage.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="acceptLicense.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupSCSI.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectInstallClass.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectKeyboard.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="doPartitionDisks.xml"/>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="resizeFATChoose.xml"/>
+
+
+ <xi:include href="takeOverHdChoose.xml"/> -->
+<xi:include href="ask_mntpoint_s.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="takeOverHdConfirm.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="formatPartitions.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="add_supplemental_media.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="media_selection.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="chooseDesktop.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="choosePackageGroups.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="minimal-install.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="choosePackagesTree.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="setRootPassword.xml">
+</xi:include> -->
+<xi:include href="addUser.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureX_chooser.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureX_card_list.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureX_monitor.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloader.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml"/>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="setupYabootGeneral.xml">
+</xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupYabootAddEntry.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="summary.xml"></xi:include> -->
+<xi:include href="misc-params.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="configureTimezoneUTC.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="selectCountry.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="configureServices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="selectMouse.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="soundConfig.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="securityLevel.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="configureNetwork.xml">
+</xi:include> -->
+<xi:include href="installUpdates.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="exitInstall.xml"/>
+
+
+ <!--STILL TO BE WRITTEN: <xi:include xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" href="uninstall-Mageia.xml"/>
+ -->
+</article>
+</book>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/DrakX.xml b/docs/installer/ja/DrakX.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..72b6a8f3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/DrakX.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><!-- Converted by db4-upgrade version 1.0 -->
+<article xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="Quick-Startup">
+ <!-- 2013-01-03 removed link to choosePackages.xml, because there is no link to it in installer. link to setupX has been removed for the same reason, before-->
+<!--2013-03-31 removed link to setupBootloaderBeginner.xml, because that page is no longer needed -->
+<!--2013-05-10 hid includes for resizeFATchoose.xml and takeOverHdChoose.xml, because since over a year ago, no one in docteam managed to make a screenshot of those installer screens. They seem to already have been obsoleted in Mandriva -->
+<!--2013-05-10 put ask_mntpoint_s.xml before takeOverHdConfirm.xml, to better reflect the order in which the links to them appear in doPartitionDisks.xml -->
+<!--2013-12-08 add soundConfig.xml -->
+<!--2014-05-07 add selectAndUseISOs2.xml Papoteur-->
+<!-- <xi:include href="drakx-intro.xml"/>
+ -->
+<info>
+ <title>Installation with DrakX</title>
+
+ <cover>
+ <para><note>
+ <para>No one will see all the installer screens that you see in this manual. Which
+screens you will see, depends on your hardware and the choices you make
+while installing.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para xml:id="CC_BY-SA">The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.</para>
+
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.</para>
+
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <xi:include href="SelectAndUseISOs2.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="installer.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectLanguage.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="acceptLicense.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupSCSI.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectInstallClass.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="selectKeyboard.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="doPartitionDisks.xml"/>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="resizeFATChoose.xml"/>
+
+
+ <xi:include href="takeOverHdChoose.xml"/> -->
+<xi:include href="ask_mntpoint_s.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="takeOverHdConfirm.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="formatPartitions.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="add_supplemental_media.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="media_selection.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="chooseDesktop.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="choosePackageGroups.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="minimal-install.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="choosePackagesTree.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="setRootPassword.xml">
+</xi:include> -->
+<xi:include href="addUser.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureX_chooser.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureX_card_list.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="configureX_monitor.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloader.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml"/>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="setupYabootGeneral.xml">
+</xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="setupYabootAddEntry.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="summary.xml"></xi:include> -->
+<xi:include href="misc-params.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="configureTimezoneUTC.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="selectCountry.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="configureServices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="selectMouse.xml"/>
+
+<xi:include href="soundConfig.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="securityLevel.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+
+
+ <!-- <xi:include href="configureNetwork.xml">
+</xi:include> -->
+<xi:include href="installUpdates.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="exitInstall.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" href="uninstall-Mageia.xml"/>
+</article>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/SelectAndUseISOs2.xml b/docs/installer/ja/SelectAndUseISOs2.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8ac38c9c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/SelectAndUseISOs2.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,460 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="Select-and-use-ISOs" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Made by Lebarhon 2014 03 26 -->
+<title xml:id="Select-and-use-ISOs-ti1">Select and use ISOs</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>Mageia is distributed via ISO images. This page will help you to choose
+which image match your needs.</para>
+
+ <para>There is two families of media:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Classical installer: After booting the media, it will follow a process
+allowing to choose what to install and how to configure your target
+system. This give you the maximal flexibility for a customized installation,
+in particular to choose which Desktop Environment you will install.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>LIVE media: you can boot the media in a real Mageia system without
+installing it, to see what you will get after installation. The
+installation process is simpler, but you get lesser choices.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>Details are given in the next sections.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Media</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Definition</title>
+
+ <para>Here, a medium (plural: media) is an ISO image file that allows you to
+install and/or update Mageia and by extension any physical support the ISO
+file is copied to.</para>
+
+ <para>You can find them <link
+ns4:href="http://www.mageia.org/en/downloads/">here</link>.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Classical installation media</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Common features</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>These ISOs use the traditional installer called drakx.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>They are able to make a clean install or an update from previous releases.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>DVD</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Different media for architecture 32 or 64 bits.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Some tools are available in the Welcome screen: Rescue System, Memory Test,
+Hardware Detection Tool.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Each DVD contains many available desktop environments and languages.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You'll be given the choice during the installation to add non free software.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>DVD dual arch</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Both architectures are present on the same medium, the choice is made
+automatically according to the detected CPU.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Uses Xfce desktop only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Not all languages are available. (be, bg, ca, de, en, es, fr, it, mk, pl,
+pt, ru, sv, uk) TO BE CHECKED!</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It contains non free software.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Live media</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Common features</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Can be used to preview the distribution without installing it on a HDD, and
+optionally install Mageia on to your HDD.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Each ISO contains only one desktop environment (KDE or GNOME).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Different media for 32 or 64 bit architectures.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Live ISOs can only be used to create clean
+installations, they cannot be used to upgrade from previous
+releases.</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>They contain non free software.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Live CD KDE</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>KDE desktop environment only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>English language only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>32 bit only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Live CD GNOME</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>GNOME desktop environment only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>English language only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>32 bit only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Live DVD KDE</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>KDE desktop environment only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>All languages are present.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Different media for 32 or 64 bit architectures.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Live DVD GNOME</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>GNOME desktop environment only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>All languages are present.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Different media for 32 or 64 bit architectures.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Boot-only CD media</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Common features</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Each one is a small image that contains no more than that which is needed to
+start the drakx installer and find drakx-installer-stage2 and other packages
+that are needed to continue and complete the install. These packages may be
+on the PC hard disk, on a local drive, on a local network or on the
+Internet.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>These media are very light (less than 100 MB) and are convenient when
+bandwidth is too low to download a full DVD, a PC without a DVD drive or a
+PC that can't boot from a USB stick.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Different media for 32 or 64 bit architectures.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>English language only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>boot.iso</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Contains only free software, for those people who refuse to use non-free
+software.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>boot-nonfree.iso</title>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Contains non-free software (mostly drivers, codecs...) for people who need
+it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Downloading and Checking Media</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Downloading</title>
+
+ <para>Once you have chosen your ISO file, you can download it using either http or
+BitTorrent. In both cases, a window gives you some information, such as the
+mirror in use and the possibility to change if the bandwidth is to low. If
+http is chosen, you may also see something like</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="Checking.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>md5sum and sha1sum are tools to check the ISO integrity. Use only one of
+them. Keep one of them <link linkend="integrity">for further
+usage</link>. Then this window appears:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="Download.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Check the radio button Save File.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="integrity">Checking the downloaded media integrity</title>
+
+ <para>Both checksums are hexadecimal numbers calculated by an algorithm from the
+file to be downloaded. When you ask these algorithms to recalculate this
+number from your downloaded file, either you have the same number and your
+downloaded file is correct, or the number is different and you have a
+failure. A failure infers that you should retry the download.</para>
+
+ <para>Open a console, no need to be root, and:</para>
+
+ <para>- To use md5sum, type: [sam@localhost]$ <userinput>md5sum
+path/to/the/image/file.iso</userinput>.</para>
+
+ <para>- To use sha1sum, type: [sam@localhost]$ <userinput>sha1sum
+path/to/the/image/file.iso</userinput>.</para>
+
+ <para>and compare the obtained number on your computer (you may have to wait for a
+while) with the number given by Mageia. Example:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="../Md5sum.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Burn or dump the ISO</title>
+
+ <para>The checked ISO can now be burned to a CD or DVD or dumped to a USB
+stick. These operations are not a simple copy and aim to make a boot-able
+medium.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Burning the ISO to a CD/DVD</title>
+
+ <para>Use whatever burner you wish but ensure the burning device is set correctly
+to <emphasis role="bold">burn an image</emphasis>, burn data or files is not
+correct. There is more information in <link
+ns4:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Writing_CD_and_DVD_images">the Mageia
+wiki</link>.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Dump the ISO to a USB stick</title>
+
+ <para>All Mageia ISOs are hybrids, which means you can 'dump' them to a USB stick
+and then use it to boot and install the system.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>"dumping" an image onto a flash device destroys any previous file-system on
+the device; any other data will be lost and the partition capacity will be
+reduced to the image size.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>To recover the original capacity, you must redo partitioning and re-format
+the USB stick.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Using a graphical tool within Mageia</title>
+
+ <para>You can use a graphical tool like <link
+ns4:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/IsoDumper_Writing_ISO_images_on_USB_sticks">IsoDumper</link></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Using a graphical tool within Windows</title>
+
+ <para>You could try:</para>
+
+ <para>- <link ns4:href="http://rufus.akeo.ie/?locale=en_US">Rufus</link> using the
+"ISO image" option;</para>
+
+ <para>- <link ns4:href="http://sourceforge.net/projects/win32diskimager">Win32
+Disk Imager</link></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Using Command line within a GNU/Linux system</title>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>It is potentially *dangerous* to do this by hand. You risk to overwrite a
+disc partition if you get the device-ID wrong.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>You can also use the dd tool in a console:</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Open a console</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Become root with the command <userinput>su -</userinput> (don't forget the
+final '-' )</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="../Root.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Plug your USB stick (do not mount it, this also means do not open any
+application or file manager that could access or read it)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Enter the command <userinput>fdisk -l</userinput></para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="../Fdisk.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Alternatively, you can get the device name with the command
+<code>dmesg</code>: at end, you see the device name starting with
+<emphasis>sd</emphasis>, and <emphasis>sdd</emphasis> in this case:</para>
+
+ <screen>[72594.604531] usb 1-1: new high-speed USB device number 27 using xhci_hcd
+[72594.770528] usb 1-1: New USB device found, idVendor=8564, idProduct=1000
+[72594.770533] usb 1-1: New USB device strings: Mfr=1, Product=2, SerialNumber=3
+[72594.770536] usb 1-1: Product: Mass Storage Device
+[72594.770537] usb 1-1: Manufacturer: JetFlash
+[72594.770539] usb 1-1: SerialNumber: 18MJTWLMPUCC3SSB
+[72594.770713] usb 1-1: ep 0x81 - rounding interval to 128 microframes, ep desc says 255 microframes
+[72594.770719] usb 1-1: ep 0x2 - rounding interval to 128 microframes, ep desc says 255 microframes
+[72594.771122] usb-storage 1-1:1.0: USB Mass Storage device detected
+[72594.772447] scsi host8: usb-storage 1-1:1.0
+[72595.963238] scsi 8:0:0:0: Direct-Access JetFlash Transcend 2GB 1100 PQ: 0 ANSI: 4
+[72595.963626] sd 8:0:0:0: [sdd] 4194304 512-byte logical blocks: (2.14 GB/2.00 GiB)
+[72595.964104] sd 8:0:0:0: [sdd] Write Protect is off
+[72595.964108] sd 8:0:0:0: [sdd] Mode Sense: 43 00 00 00
+[72595.965025] sd 8:0:0:0: [sdd] No Caching mode page found
+[72595.965031] sd 8:0:0:0: [sdd] Assuming drive cache: write through
+[72595.967251] <emphasis>sdd</emphasis>: sdd1
+[72595.969446] sd 8:0:0:0: [sdd] Attached SCSI removable disk</screen>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Find the device name for your USB stick (by its size), for example
+<code>/dev/sdb</code> in the screenshot above, it is a 8GB USB stick.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Enter the command: # <userinput>dd if=path/to/the/ISO/file of=/dev/sdX
+bs=1M</userinput></para>
+
+ <para>Where X=your device name eg: /dev/sdc</para>
+
+ <para>Example: # <userinput>dd if=/home/user/Downloads/Mageia-4-x86_64-DVD.iso
+of=/dev/sdb bs=1M</userinput></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Enter the command: # <userinput>sync</userinput></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Unplug your USB stick, it is done</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/acceptLicense.xml b/docs/installer/ja/acceptLicense.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ff881d01
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/acceptLicense.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="acceptLicense" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 27 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- JohnR: minor mods 2012-3-30 -->
+<!-- SimonNZG 2012-04-03 has taken a look but needs to come back -->
+<!-- JohnR: 2012-04-05 - Inserted text from barjac with some modifications:
+ http://mtf.no-ip.co.uk/doc/help/license.html -->
+<!-- marja:2012-04-05 - having a look because this isn't a DocBook5.0 type anymore,
+ but text/xml. First changing centimetres in screenshot to pixels (
+ ), after that nested the two existing sections into a third one-->
+<!-- removed para id's, corrected duplicate id's for segments, marja, 20120409 -->
+<!-- barjac:2012-04-10 - edited header to correct formatting after my saves - not
+ sure what is causing the corruption -->
+<!-- JohnR 2012-04-19 language proofreading -->
+<title xml:id="acceptLicense-ti1">ライセンスとリリース ノート</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject condition="classical"> <imagedata xml:id="acceptLicense-im1"
+revision="4" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="dx2-license.png"/>
+</imageobject> <imageobject> <imagedata xml:id="acceptLicense-im2"
+revision="5" align="center" condition="live" format="PNG"
+fileref="live-license.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <section xml:id="license">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="license-ti1">使用許諾に同意する</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para><application>Mageia</application> をインストールする前に使用許諾をお読みください。</para>
+
+ <para>These terms and conditions apply to the entire
+<application>Mageia</application> distribution and must be accepted before
+you can continue.</para>
+
+ <para>To accept, simply select <guilabel>Accept</guilabel> and then click on
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para>If you decide not to accept these conditions, then we thank you for
+looking. Clicking <guibutton>Quit</guibutton> will reboot your computer.</para>
+
+
+ <!-- if you want two sections in a file, both need to be nested in a third section -
+ marja, 20120405 -->
+</section>
+
+ <section xml:id="releaseNotes">
+ <!--
+ <para>
+Release Notes</para>
+-->
+<info>
+ <title xml:id="releaseNotes-ti1">リリースノート</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <para>Important information are given about this release of
+<application>Mageia</application> and are accessible clicking on the
+<guibutton>Release Notes</guibutton> button.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/addUser.xml b/docs/installer/ja/addUser.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..26df1c7b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/addUser.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,161 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="addUser" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="addUser-ti1">User and Superuser Management</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Started by marja,using Led43's text, on 2012 03 27 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- SimonNZG 2012-04-03 has taken a look but needs to come back -->
+<!-- removed para xml:id's, finished the page using Led43's text in the wiki, but
+ changed his text about the Advanced User Managment screen (the only thing
+ about guest account there, is the box you can tick or untick to enable or
+ disable it, the rest is about the normal user you're adding in the previous
+ screen), marja, 20120409-->
+<!-- barjac 2012-04-13 moved explanation of xguest lower down. I don't understand
+ "rbash" in the xguest warning - is that correct? -->
+<!-- JohnR 2012-04-19 Language proofreading -->
+<!-- marja 2012-04-24 Added screenshot -->
+<!-- marja 2013-04-26 added new note-->
+<imageobject condition="classical"> <imagedata revision="1" align="center"
+xml:id="setRootPassword-im1" fileref="dx2-setRootPassword.png"
+format="PNG"/> </imageobject> <imageobject> <imagedata format="PNG"
+fileref="live-user1.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <section xml:id="root-password">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="root-password-ti2">Set Administrator (root) Password:</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>It is advisable for all <application>Mageia</application> installations to
+set a superuser or administrator's password, usually called the
+<emphasis>root password</emphasis> in Linux. As you type a password into the
+top box the colour of its shield will change from red to yellow to green
+depending on the strength of the password. A green shield shows you are
+using a strong password. You need to repeat the same password in the box
+just below the first password box, this checks that you have not mistyped
+the first password by comparing them.</para>
+
+ <note xml:id="givePassword">
+ <para>All passwords are case sensitive, it is best to use a mixture of letters
+(upper and lower case), numbers and other characters in a password.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="enterUser">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="enterUser-ti3">ユーザ名を入力</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>Add a user here. A user has fewer rights than the superuser (root), but
+enough to surf the internet, use office applications or play games and
+anything else the average user does with his computer</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guibutton>Icon</guibutton>: if you click on this button it will change the
+users icon.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Real Name</guilabel>: Insert the users real name into this text
+box.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Login Name</guilabel>: Here you enter the user login name or let
+drakx use a version of the users real name. <emphasis>The login name is case
+sensitive.</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Password</guilabel>: In this text box you should type in the user
+password. There is a shield at the end of the text box that indicates the
+strength of the password. (See also <xref linkend="givePassword"/>)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Password (again)</guilabel>: Retype the user password into this
+text box and drakx will check you have the same password in each of the user
+password text boxes.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Any user you add while installing Mageia, will have a world readable (but
+write protected) home directory.</para>
+
+ <para>However, while using your new install, any user you add in <emphasis>MCC -
+System - Manage users on system</emphasis> will have a home directory that
+is both read and write protected.</para>
+
+ <para>If you don't want a world readable home directory for anyone, it is advised
+to only add a temporary user now and to add the real one(s) after reboot.</para>
+
+ <para>If you prefer world readable home directories, you might want to add all
+extra needed users in the <emphasis>Configuration - Summary</emphasis> step
+during the install. Choose <emphasis>User management</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>The access permissions can also be changed after the install.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+
+ <section condition="classical" xml:id="addUserAdvanced">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="addUserAdvanced-ti3">Advanced User Management</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>If the <guibutton>advanced</guibutton> button is clicked you are offered a
+screen that allows you to edit the settings for the user you are adding.</para>
+
+ <para condition="classical">Additionally, you can disable or enable a guest account.</para>
+
+ <warning condition="classical">
+ <para>Anything a guest with a default <emphasis>rbash</emphasis> guest account
+saves to his /home directory will be erased when he logs out. The guest
+should save his important files to a USB key.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem condition="classical">
+ <para><guilabel>Enable guest account</guilabel>: Here you can enable or disable a
+guest account. The guest account allows a guest to log into and use the PC,
+but he has more restricted access than normal users.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Shell</guilabel>: This drop down list allows you to change the
+shell used by the user you are adding in the previous screen, options are
+Bash, Dash and Sh</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>User ID</guilabel>: Here you can set the user ID for the user you
+are adding in the previous screen. This is a number. Leave it blank unless
+you know what you are doing.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Group ID</guilabel>: This lets you set the group ID. Also a
+number, usually the same one as for the user. Leave it blank unless you know
+what you are doing.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/add_supplemental_media.xml b/docs/installer/ja/add_supplemental_media.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..71a68ea5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/add_supplemental_media.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="add_supplemental_media"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="add_supplemental_media-ti1">Media Selection (Configure Supplemental Installation Media)</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!-- papoteur 2013-04-13 - created -->
+<!-- marja 2013-04-16 added screenshot and expanded title (because is was the same as for media_selection -->
+<!-- marja 2013-04-16 s/a optical/an optcal/ s/support/disc/ s/or or/or/ s/at/during/ as suggested by Tristan Campbell -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center"
+fileref="dx2-add_supplemental_media.png" format="PNG" revision="1"
+xml:id="dx2-add_supplemental_media-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This screen gives you the list of already recognized repositories. You can
+add other sources for packages, like an optical disc or a remote source. The
+source selection determines which packages will be available for selection
+during the next steps.</para>
+
+ <para>For a network source, there are two steps to follow:</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Choosing and activation of the network, if not already up. </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Selecting a mirror or specifying a URL (very first entry). By selecting a
+mirror, you have access to the selection of all repositories managed by
+Mageia, like the Nonfree , the Tainted repositories and the Updates. With
+the URL, you can designate a specific repository or your own NFS
+installation.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you are updating a 64 bit installation which may contain some 32 bit
+packages, it is advised to use this screen to add an online mirror by
+ticking one of the Network protocols here. The 64 bit DVD iso only contains
+64 bit and noarch packages, it will not be able to update the 32 bit
+packages. However, after adding an online mirror, installer will find the
+needed 32 bit packages there.</para>
+ </note>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/ask_mntpoint_s.xml b/docs/installer/ja/ask_mntpoint_s.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a2a51590
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/ask_mntpoint_s.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xml:id="ask_mntpoint_s" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="ask_mntpoint_s-ti1">マウントポイントを選択</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 28 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- SimonNZG 2012-04-03 has taken a look but needs to come back -->
+<!-- removed para xml:id's, marja, 20120409 -->
+<!-- barjac 14/04/2012 Minor edit to improve grammar and replaced "at least ONE"
+ with "a", as I can't imagine having more than one root partition ;) -->
+<!-- Lebarhon : I put [] where it seems having mistakes -->
+<!-- Marja: you're right, in English English it is "its type", however, the Americans
+ write "it's type". And you're right about the redundant part, too, I removed it-->
+<!-- And JohnR says the Americans are WRONG! :-)) -->
+<!-- 2012-04-19 Language proofreading done -->
+<imageobject condition='classical'> <imagedata revision="1"
+fileref="dx2-chooseMountpoints.png" align="center" format="PNG"
+xml:id="chooseMountPoints-im1"></imagedata> </imageobject> <imageobject
+condition='live'> <imagedata revision="1"
+fileref="live-chooseMountpoints.png" align="center" format="PNG"
+xml:id="live-chooseMountPoints-im1"></imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here you see the Linux partitions that have been found on your computer. If
+you don't agree with the <application>DrakX</application> suggestions, you
+can change the mount points.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you change anything, make sure you still have a <literal>/</literal>
+(root) partition.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Every partition is shown as follows: "Device" ("Capacity", "Mount point",
+"Type").</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>"Device", is made up of: "hard drive", ["hard drive number"(letter)],
+"partition number" (for example, "sda5").</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If you have many partitions, you can choose many different mount points from
+the drop down menu, such as <literal>/</literal>, <literal>/home</literal>
+and <literal>/var</literal>. You can even make your own mount points, for
+instance <literal>/video</literal> for a partition where you want to store
+your films, or <literal>/cauldron-home</literal> for the
+<literal>/home</literal> partition of a cauldron install.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>For partitions you don't need to have access to, you can leave the mount
+point field blank.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Choose <guibutton>Previous</guibutton> if you are not sure what to choose,
+and then tick <guilabel>Custom disk partitioning</guilabel>. In the screen
+that follows, you can click on a partition to see its type and size.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>If you are sure the mount points are correct, click on
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>, and choose whether you only want to format the
+partition(s) DrakX suggests, or more.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/bestTime.xml b/docs/installer/ja/bestTime.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..7d541d49
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/bestTime.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,21 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="bestTime"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="bestTime-ti1">Clock settings</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject condition="live">
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="live-bestTime.png"
+format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="bestTime-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this step, you have to select on which time your internal clock is set,
+either local time or UTC time.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced tab, you will find more options about clock settings.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/bootLive.xml b/docs/installer/ja/bootLive.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2abcb44e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/bootLive.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="bootLive" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="bootLive-ti1">Boot Mageia as Live system</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <section xml:id="bootLive-1">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="bootLive1-ti1">Booting the medium</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <section>
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="bootLive11-ti1">From a disc</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>You can boot directly from the media you used to burn your image (CD-ROM,
+DVD-ROM...). You usually just need to insert it in your CD/DVD drive for the
+bootloader to launch the installation automatically after rebooting the
+computer. If that does not happen you may need to reconfigure your BIOS or
+press one key that will offer you to choose the peripheral from which the
+computer will boot.</para>
+
+ <para>According to which hardware you have, and how it is configured, you get
+either one or another of the two screens below.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="bootLive12-ti1">From a USB device</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>You can boot from the USB device on which you dumped your image
+ISO. According to your BIOS settings, the computer boots perhaps directly on
+the USB device already plugged in a port. If that does not happen you may
+need to reconfigure your BIOS or press one key that will offer you to choose
+the peripheral from which the computer will boot.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="biosmode">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="biosmode-ti1">In BIOS/CSM/Legacy mode</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject> <imagedata fileref="live-bootCSM.png"/> </imageobject>
+
+ <caption>
+ <para>First screen while booting in BIOS mode</para>
+ </caption>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In the middle menu, you have the choice between three actions:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Boot Mageia: That means Mageia 5 will start from the connected media (CD/DVD
+or USB stick) without writing anything on the disk, so expect a very slow
+system. Once the boot is done, you can proceed to the installation on a hard
+disk.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Install Mageia: This choice will directly install Mageia on a hard disk.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Boot from hard disk: This choice allows to boot from hard disk, as usual,
+when no media (CD/DVD or USB stick) is connected. (not working with Mageia
+5).</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>In the bottom menu, are the Boot Options:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>F1 - Help. Explain the options "splash", "apm", "acpi" and "Ide"</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>F2 - Language. Choose the display language of the screens.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>F3 - Screen resolution. Choose between text, 640x400, 800x600, 1024x728</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>F4 - CD-Rom. CD-Rom or Other. Normally, the installation is performed from
+the inserted installation medium. Here, select other sources, like FTP or
+NFS servers. If the installation is carried out in a network with an SLP
+server, select one of the installation sources available on the server with
+this option.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>F5 - Driver. Yes or No. The system is aware about the presence of an
+optional disk with a driver update and will require its insertion during
+installation process.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>F6 - Kernel options. This is a way to specify options according to your
+hardware and the drivers to use.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="uefimode">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="uefimode-ti1">In UEFI mode</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject condition="live">
+ <imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" align="center"
+fileref="live-bootUEFI.png" format="PNG" xml:id="bootUEFI-im1"/>
+</imageobject>
+
+ <caption>
+ <para>First screen while booting on UEFI system from disk</para>
+ </caption>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You have only the choice to run Mageia in Live mode (first choice) or to
+process the installation (second choice).</para>
+ <para>If you booted from a USB stick, you get two supplemental lines which are a
+duplicata of the previous lines suffixed with "USB". You have to choose
+them.</para>
+
+ <para>In each case, the first steps will be the same to choose language, timezone
+and keyboard, then the processes differ, with <link
+linkend="testing">additional steps in Live mode</link>.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/chooseDesktop.xml b/docs/installer/ja/chooseDesktop.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8fc9b28d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/chooseDesktop.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,33 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="chooseDesktop">
+
+
+ <!--2012-12-26 marja - exported this section from choosePackages.xml to start a new page-->
+<info>
+ <title xml:id="chooseDesktop-ti1">デスクトップの選択</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+ <para>Depending on your selection here, you may be offered further screens to fine
+tune your choice.</para>
+
+ <para>After the selection step(s), you will see a slide show during package
+installation. The slide show can be disabled by pressing the
+<guilabel>Details</guilabel> button</para>
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-chooseDesktop.png" align="center"
+format="PNG" ></imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose whether you prefer to use the <application>KDE</application> or
+<application>Gnome</application> desktop environment. Both come with a full
+set of useful applications and tools. Tick <guilabel>Custom</guilabel> if
+you want to use neither or both, or if you want something other than the
+default software choices for these desktop environments. The
+<application>LXDE</application> desktop is lighter than the previous two,
+sporting less eye candy and fewer packages installed by default.</para>
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/choosePackageGroups.xml b/docs/installer/ja/choosePackageGroups.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a2baba92
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/choosePackageGroups.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="choosePackageGroups">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="choosePackageGroups-ti1">パッケージグループを選択</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!--2012-12-26 marja - exported this section from choosePackages.xml to start a new page-->
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-choosePackageGroups.png"
+align="center" format="PNG" ></imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Packages have been sorted into groups, to make choosing what you need on
+your system a lot easier. The groups are fairly self explanatory, however
+more information about the content of each is available in tool-tips which
+become visible as the mouse is hovered over them.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Workstation.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Server.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Graphical Environment.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Individual Package Selection: You can use this option to manually add or
+remove packages.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ <para>Read <xref linkend="minimal-install"></xref> for instructions on how to do a
+minimal install (without or with X &amp; IceWM).</para>
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/choosePackagesTree.xml b/docs/installer/ja/choosePackagesTree.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c1cf9796
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/choosePackagesTree.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="choosePackagesTree">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="choosePackagesTree-ti1">Choose Individual Packages</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!--2012-12-26 marja - exported this section from choosePackages.xml to start a new page-->
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-choosePackagesTree.png" align="center"
+format="PNG" ></imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here you can add or remove any extra packages to customise your
+installation.</para>
+
+ <para>After having made your choice, you can click on the <guibutton>floppy
+icon</guibutton> at the bottom of the page to save your choice of packages
+(saving to a USB key works, too). You can then use this file to install the
+same packages on another system, by pressing the same button during install
+and choosing to load it.</para>
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/configureServices.xml b/docs/installer/ja/configureServices.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..99c07f41
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/configureServices.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xml:id="configureServices" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="configureServices-ti1">Configure your Services</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!-- 2012-12-25 marja - moved this section out of misc-params.xml -->
+<!-- 2013-05-05 marja - added screenshot -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-configureServices.png"
+align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="configureServices-im1"></imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureServices-pa1">Here you can set which services should (not) start when you boot your
+system.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureServices-pa2">There are four groups, click on the triangle before a group to expand it and
+see all services in it.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureServices-pa3">The setting DrakX chose are usually good.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureServices-pa4">If you highlight a service, some information about it is shown in the info
+box below.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureServices-pa5">Only change things when you know very well what you are doing.</para>
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/configureTimezoneUTC.xml b/docs/installer/ja/configureTimezoneUTC.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c56697ff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/configureTimezoneUTC.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="configureTimezoneUTC">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="configureTimezoneUTC-ti6">Configure your Timezone</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- 2012-12-25 marja - moved this part out of misc-params.xml -->
+<!-- 2013-05-05 marja - added screenshot -->
+<imageobject condition="classical"> <imagedata
+xml:id="configureTimezoneUTC-im1" revision="1"
+fileref="dx2-configureTimezoneUTC.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+</imageobject> <imageobject> <imagedata fileref="live-timeZone.png"
+condition="live" format="PNG"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureTimezoneUTC-pa1">Choose your time zone by choosing your country or a city close to you in the
+same time zone.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureTimezoneUTC-pa2">In next screen you can choose to set your hardware clock to local time or to
+GMT, also known as UTC.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureTimezoneUTC-pa3">If you have more than one operating system on your computer, make sure they
+are all set to local time, or all to UTC/GMT.</para>
+ </note>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/configureX_card_list.xml b/docs/installer/ja/configureX_card_list.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6a6ca0f0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/configureX_card_list.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,59 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="configureX_card_list">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Initiated by Marja 2012-08-08 -->
+<!-- Further text JohnR 2012-08-29 -->
+<!-- tproof -->
+<!-- lproof -->
+<!-- Done corrections accordind to tmb remarks. Papoteur -->
+<title xml:id="configureX_card_list-ti1">Choose an X Server (Configure your Graphic Card)</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" align="center"
+xml:id="configureX_card_list-im1" fileref="dx2-configureX_card_list.png"
+format="PNG"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>DrakX has a very comprehensive database of video cards and will usually
+correctly identify your video device.</para>
+
+ <para>If the installer has not correctly detected your graphic card and you know
+which one you have, you can select it from the tree by: <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>vendor</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>then the name of your card</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>and the type of card</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+
+ <para>If you cannot find your card in the vendor lists (because it's not yet in
+the database or it's an older card) you may find a suitable driver in the
+Xorg category</para>
+
+ <para>The Xorg listing provides more than 40 generic and open source video card
+drivers. If you still can't find a named driver for your card there is the
+option of using the vesa driver which provides basic capabilities.</para>
+
+ <para>Be aware that if you select an incompatible driver you may only have access
+to the Commandline Interface.</para>
+
+ <para>Some video card manufacturers provide proprietary drivers for Linux which
+may only be available in the Nonfree repository and in some cases only from
+the card manufacturers' websites.</para>
+
+ <para>The Nonfree repository needs to be explicitly enabled to access them. If
+you didn't select it previously, you should do this after your first reboot.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/configureX_chooser.xml b/docs/installer/ja/configureX_chooser.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4872f658
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/configureX_chooser.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,64 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="configureX_chooser" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="configureX_chooser-ti1">Graphic Card and Monitor Configuration</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Marja 2012-08-10, copied setupX.xml to this file and replaced all "setupX" in the code by "configureX_chooser", because this is the correct filename for this page-->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-configureX_chooser.png"
+align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="configureX_chooser-im1"> </imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa1">No matter which graphical environment (also known as desktop environment)
+you chose for this install of <application>Mageia</application>, they are
+all based on a graphical user interface system called <acronym>X Window
+System</acronym>, or simply <acronym>X</acronym>. So in order for
+<acronym>KDE</acronym>, <acronym>Gnome</acronym>, <acronym>LXDE</acronym> or
+any other graphical environment to work well, the following
+<acronym>X</acronym> settings need to be correct. Choose the correct
+settings if you can see that <application>DrakX</application> didn't make a
+choice, or if you think the choice is incorrect.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa2"><emphasis><guibutton>Graphic card</guibutton></emphasis>: Choose your card
+from the list if needed.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa3"><emphasis><guibutton>Monitor</guibutton></emphasis>: You can choose
+<guilabel>Plug'n Play</guilabel> when applicable, or choose your monitor
+from the <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> or <guilabel>Generic</guilabel>
+list. Choose <guilabel>Custom</guilabel> if you prefer to manually set the
+horizontal and vertical refresh rates of your monitor.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa3a">Incorrect refresh rates may damage your monitor</para>
+ </warning>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa4"><emphasis><guibutton>Resolution</guibutton></emphasis>: Set the desired
+resolution and color depth of your monitor here.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa5"><emphasis><guibutton>Test</guibutton></emphasis>: The test button does not
+always appear during install. If the button is there, you can control your
+settings by pressing it. If you see a question asking you whether your
+settings are correct, you can answer "yes", and the settings will be
+kept. If you don't see anything, you'll return to the configuration screen
+and be able to reconfigure everything until the test is good. <emphasis>Make
+sure your settings are on the safe side if the test button isn't
+available</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_chooser-pa6"><emphasis><guibutton>Options</guibutton></emphasis>: Here you can choose to
+enable or disable various options.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/configureX_monitor.xml b/docs/installer/ja/configureX_monitor.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a217564e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/configureX_monitor.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,83 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="configureX_monitor"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Initiated by Marga 2012-8-09 -->
+<!-- Further text JohnR 2012-08-30 -->
+<!-- tproof -->
+<!-- lproof -->
+<title xml:id="configureX_monitor-ti1">Choosing your Monitor</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa1">DrakX has a very comprehensive database of monitors and will usually
+correctly identify yours.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa1w"><emphasis>Selecting a monitor with different characteristics could damage
+your monitor or video hardware. Please don't try something without knowing
+what you are doing.</emphasis> If in doubt you should consult your monitor
+documentation</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="dx2-configureX_monitor.png"
+format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1"
+ xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa2"><emphasis>Custom</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa3">This option allows you to set two critical parameters, the vertical refresh
+rate and the horizontal sync rate. Vertical refresh determines how often the
+screen is refreshed and horizontal sync is the rate at which scan lines are
+displayed.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa4">It is <emphasis>VERY IMPORTANT</emphasis> that you do not specify a monitor
+type with a sync range that is beyond the capabilities of your monitor: you
+may damage your monitor. If in doubt, choose a conservative setting and
+consult your monitor documentation.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa5"><emphasis>Plug 'n Play</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa6">This is the default option and tries to determine the monitor type from the
+monitor database.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1"
+ xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa7"><emphasis>Vendor</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa8">If the installer has not correctly detected your monitor and you know which
+one you have, you can select it from the tree by selecting: <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>vendor</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the monitor manufacturers name</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the monitor description</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+
+ <para revision="1"
+ xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa9"><emphasis>Generic</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="configureX_monitor-pa10">selecting this group displays nearly 30 display configurations such as
+1024x768 @ 60Hz and includes Flat panel displays as used in laptops. This is
+often a good monitor selection group if you need to use the Vesa card driver
+when your video hardware cannot be determined automatically. Once again it
+may be wise to be conservative in your selections.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/diskdrake.xml b/docs/installer/ja/diskdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..45667a6b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/diskdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,67 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="diskdrake">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Started by marja on 2012 03 29 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE WRITTEN AND THEN REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- JohnR added note for bug 133 re encrypted partitions -->
+<!-- JohnR 2012-04-10 - tidy up module formatting -->
+<!-- Marja, 2012-04-18 changed "If you wish to use encryption on
+ any of your partitions" into "If you wish to use encryption on
+ your <literal>
+/</literal> partition" because pterjan said this is only for root
+ Also added some text. -->
+<!--marja 20120418 moved section end tag down to where it belongs-->
+<!--marja 20120418 added para 6a-->
+<title xml:id="diskdrake-ti1">Custom disk partitioning with DiskDrake</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject condition='classical'> <imagedata fileref="dx2-diskdrake.png"
+align="center"/> </imageobject> <imageobject condition='live' > <imagedata
+fileref="live-diskdrake.png" align="center"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para revision="3" xml:id="diskdrake-pa1">If you wish to use encryption on your <literal>/</literal> partition you
+must ensure that you have a separate <literal>/boot</literal> partition. The
+encryption option for the <literal>/boot</literal> partition must NOT be
+set, otherwise your system will be unbootable.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="diskdrake-pa3">Adjust the layout of your disk(s) here. You can remove or create
+partitions, change the filesystem of a partition or change its size and even
+view what is in them before you start.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake-pa4">There is a tab for every detected hard disk or other storage device, like an
+USB key. For example sda, sdb and sdc if there are three of them.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake-pa5">Push <guibutton>Clear all</guibutton> to wipe all partitions on the selected
+storage device</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake-pa6">For all other actions: click on the desired partition first. Then view it,
+or choose a filesystem and a mount point, resize it or wipe it.</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="diskdrake-pa6a" revision="1">Continue until you adjusted everything to your wishes.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake-pa7">Click <guibutton>Done</guibutton> when you're ready.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you are installing Mageia on an UEFI system, check that an ESP (EFI
+System Partition) is present and correctly mounted on /boot/EFI (see above)</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-diskdrake2.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject></para>
+ </note>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/doPartitionDisks.xml b/docs/installer/ja/doPartitionDisks.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..cb1f7cdd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/doPartitionDisks.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,141 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="doPartitionDisks">
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!---->
+<!-- lebarhon 2015-07-03 Suggested updates for Mageia 5 -->
+<title xml:id="doPartitionDisks-ti1">パーティションの設定</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa1">In this screen you can see the content of your hard drive(s) and see the
+solutions the DrakX partitioning wizard found for where to install
+<application>Mageia</application>.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa2">The options available from the list below will vary depending on your
+particular hard drive(s) layout and content.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="dx2-doPartitionDisks.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa3"><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa4">Use Existing Partitions</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa5">If this option is available, then existing Linux compatible partitions have
+been found and may be used for the installation.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa6">Use Free Space</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa7">If you have unused space on your hard drive then this option will use it for
+your new Mageia installation.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa8">Use Free Space on a Windows Partition</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa9">If you have unused space on an existing Windows partition, the installer may
+offer to use it.</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa10" revision="2">This can be a useful way of making room for your new Mageia installation,
+but is a risky operation so you should make sure you have backed up all
+important files!</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa11" revision="3">Note that this involves shrinking the size of the Windows partition. The
+partition must be "clean", meaning that Windows must have closed down
+correctly the last time it was used. It must also have been defragmented,
+although this is not a guarantee that all files in the partition have been
+moved out of the area that is about to be used. It is highly recommended to
+back up your personal files.</para>
+
+ <para>With this option, the installer displays the remaining Windows partition in
+light blue and the future Mageia partition in dark blue with their intended
+sizes just under. You have the possibility to adapt these sizes by clicking
+and dragging the gap between both partitions. See the screen-shot below.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-doPartitionDisks2.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist> <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa12">Erase and use Entire Disk.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa13">This option will use the complete drive for Mageia.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa14">Note! This will erase ALL data on the selected hard drive. Take care!</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa15">If you intend to use part of the disk for something else, or you already
+have data on the drive that you are not prepared to lose, then do not use
+this option.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa16">カスタム</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="doPartitionDisks-pa17">This gives you complete control over the placing of the installation on your
+hard drive(s).</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Partitions sizing:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>The installer will share the available place out according to the following
+rules:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the total available place is lower than 50 GB, only one partition is
+created for /, there is no separate partition for /home.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the total available place is over 50 GB, then three partitions are
+created</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>6/19 of the total available place is allocated to / with a maximum of 50 GB</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>1/19 is allocated to swap with a maximum of 4 GB</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the rest (at least 12/19) is allocated to /home</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+
+ <para>That means that from 160 GB and over of available place, the installer will
+create three partitions: 50 GB for /, 4 GB for swap and the rest for /home.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you are using an UEFI system, the ESP (EFI System Partition) will be
+automatically detected, or created if it does not exist yet, and mounted on
+/boot/EFI. The "Custom" option is the only one that allows to check it has
+been correctly done</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Some newer drives are now using 4096 byte logical sectors, instead of the
+previous standard of 512 byte logical sectors. Due to lack of available
+hardware, the partitioning tool used in the installer has not been tested
+with such a drive. Also some ssd drives now use an erase block size over 1
+MB. We suggest to pre-partition the drive, using an alternative partitioning
+tool like gparted, if you own such a device, and to use the following
+settings:</para>
+
+ <para>"Align to" "MiB"</para>
+
+ <para>"Free space preceding (MiB)" "2"</para>
+
+ <para>Also make sure all partitions are created with an even number of megabytes.</para>
+ </warning>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/exitInstall.xml b/docs/installer/ja/exitInstall.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ec4ad07f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/exitInstall.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="exitInstall" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="exitInstall-ti1">おめでとうございます</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Started by marja on 2012 03 29 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE WRITTEN AND THEN REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- marja - 2012-04-24 added screenshot and text -->
+<!-- same day, added "s" to "sytems"-->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-exitInstall.png"
+format="PNG" align="center" xml:id="exitInstall-im1"> </imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="exitInstall-pa1">You have finished installing and configuring
+<application>Mageia</application> and it is now safe to remove the
+installation medium and reboot your computer.</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="exitInstall-pa2">After reboot, in the bootloader screen, you can choose between the operating
+systems on your computer (if you have more than one).</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="exitInstall-pa3">If you didn't adjust the settings for the bootloader, your Mageia install
+will be automatically selected and started. </para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="exitInstall-pa4">Enjoy!</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="exitInstall-pa5">Visit www.mageia.org if you have any questions or want to contribute to
+Mageia </para>
+
+
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/formatPartitions.xml b/docs/installer/ja/formatPartitions.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..181249ef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/formatPartitions.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="formatPartitions">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="formatPartitions-ti1">Formatting</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 29 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- marja 2012-04-24 added screenshot -->
+<!-- marja 2012-04-24 added emphasis tags in formatPartitions-pa1 -->
+<imageobject condition='classical'> <imagedata revision="1"
+fileref="dx2-formatPartitions.png" format="PNG" align="center"
+xml:id="formatPartitions-im1"> </imagedata> </imageobject> <imageobject
+condition='live'> <imagedata revision="1"
+fileref="live-formatPartitions.png" format="PNG" align="center"
+xml:id="live-formatPartitions-im1"> </imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="formatPartitions-pa1">Here you can choose which partition(s) you wish to format. Any data on
+partitions <emphasis>not</emphasis> marked for formatting will be saved.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="formatPartitions-pa2">Usually at least the partitions DrakX selected, need to be formatted</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="formatPartitions-pa3">Click on <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> to choose partitions you want to
+check for so called <emphasis>bad blocks</emphasis></para>
+
+ <tip>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="formatPartitions-pa4">If you're not sure you have made the right choice, you can click on
+<guibutton>Previous</guibutton>, again on <guibutton>Previous</guibutton>
+and then on <guibutton>Custom</guibutton> to get back to the main screen.
+In that screen you can choose to view what is in your partitions.</para>
+ </tip>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="formatPartitions-pa5">When you are confident about the selection, click on
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> to continue.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/installUpdates.xml b/docs/installer/ja/installUpdates.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4077999c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/installUpdates.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="installUpdates"><info><title xml:id="installUpdates-ti1">更新</title></info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 30 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- marja 20120418 removed xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"" from section tag, trying to restore correct html filename-->
+<!-- marja, 2012-04-24 added screenshot -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-installUpdates.png"
+format="PNG" align="center" xml:id="installUpdates-im1"></imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="installUpdates-pa1">Since this version of <application>Mageia</application> was released, some
+packages will have been updated or improved.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="installUpdates-pa2">Choose <guilabel>yes</guilabel> if you wish to download and install them,
+select <guilabel>no</guilabel> if you don't want to do this now, or if you
+aren't connected to the Internet</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="installUpdates-pa3">Then press <guibutton>Next</guibutton> to continue</para>
+
+</section>
+ \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/installer.xml b/docs/installer/ja/installer.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f66281bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/installer.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,270 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="installer" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 30, using barjac's text -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!--removed para id's, corrected duplicate id's for segments, marja, 20120409 -->
+<!--barjac 2012-04-11 - corrected link to Welcome screen and unmangled header -
+ seems to be corrupted by xxe addon when saving -->
+<!-- JohnR - apparent corruption is caused by the positioning of this comment block
+ - corrected Lebarhon : I put [] where it seems having mistakes -->
+<!-- barjac 18/04/2012 Commented out para relating to peripherals, as it's apparently wrong -->
+<title xml:id="installer-ti1">DrakX, the Mageia Installer</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>Whether you are new to GNU-Linux or an experienced user, the Mageia
+Installer is designed to help make your installation or upgrade as easy as
+possible.</para>
+
+
+
+ <!-- <para>
+If you have peripherals like printers or scanners, it is [best] to
+ connect them and make sure they are powered up during installation. These
+ will be automatically detected and configured.</para> -->
+<para>The initial menu screen has various options, however the default one will
+start the installer, which will normally be all that you will need.</para>
+
+ <figure xml:id="dx-welcome">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="installer-ti2">Installation Welcome Screen</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>Here are the default welcome screens when using a Mageia DVD, The first one
+with a legacy system and the second one with an UEFI system:
+ </para>
+
+<mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata xml:id="BId-drakx-intro-im1" revision="1"
+align="center" format="PNG" fileref="../dx-welcome.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject></figure>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx-welcome2.png" align="center"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>From this first screen, it is possible to set some personal preferences:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The language (for the installation only, may be different that the chosen
+language for the system) by pressing the key F2 (Legacy mode only)</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx-welcome-lang.png" align="center"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Use the arrow keys to select the language and press the key Enter.</para>
+
+ <para>Here is for example, the French welcome screen when using a Live
+DVD/CD. Note that the Live DVD/CD menu does not propose: <guilabel>Rescue
+System</guilabel>, <guilabel>Memory test</guilabel> and <guilabel>Hardware
+Detection Tool</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx-welcome4fr.png" align="center"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Change the screen resolution by pressing the F3 key (Legacy mode only).</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx-welcome5def.png" align="center"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Add some kernel options by pressing the <emphasis role="bold">F6</emphasis>
+key for the legacy mode or the <emphasis role="bold">e</emphasis> key for
+the UEFI mode.</para>
+
+ <para>If the installation fails, then it may be necessary to try again using one
+of the extra options. The menu called by F6 displays a new line called
+<guilabel>Boot options</guilabel> and propose four entries:</para>
+
+ <para>- Default, it doesn't alter anything in the default options.</para>
+
+ <para>- Safe Settings, priority is given to the safer options to the detriment of
+performances.</para>
+
+ <para>- No ACPI (Advanced Configuration and Power Interface), power management
+isn't taken into account.</para>
+
+ <para>- No Local APIC (Local Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller), it is
+about CPU interruptions, select this option if you are asked for.</para>
+
+ <para>When you select one of these entries, it modifies the default options
+displayed in the <guilabel>Boot Options</guilabel> line.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>In some Mageia releases, it may happen that the entries selected with the
+key F6 does not appear in the <guilabel>Boot Options</guilabel> line,
+however, they are really taken into account.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="dx-welcome6opt.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Add more kernel options by pressing the key F1 (Legacy mode only).</para>
+
+ <para>Pressing F1 opens a new window with more available options. Select one with
+the arrow keys and press Enter to have more details or press the Esc key to
+go back to the welcome screen.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx-welcomeHelp1.png" align="center"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>The detailed view about the option splash. Press Esc or select
+<guilabel>Return to Boot Options</guilabel> to go back to the options
+list. These options can by added by hand in the <guilabel>Boot
+options</guilabel> line.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="dx-welcomeHelp2.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>The help is translated in the chosen language with the F2 key.</para>
+ </note>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>For more information about kernel options on legacy and UEFI systems, see:
+<link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/How_to_set_up_kernel_options">https://wiki.mageia.org/en/How_to_set_up_kernel_options</link></para>
+
+ <para>Here is the default welcome screen when using a Wired Network-based
+Installation CD (Boot.iso or Boot-Nonfree.iso images):</para>
+
+ <para>It does not allow to change the language, the available options are
+described in the screen. For more information about using a Wired
+Network-based Installation CD, see <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Boot.iso_install">the Mageia
+Wiki</link></para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>The keyboard layout is the American one.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="installer-im2" align="center"
+format="PNG" fileref="../dx-help.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <section xml:id="installationSteps">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="installationSteps-ti1">The installation steps</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>The install process is divided into a number of steps, which can be followed
+on the side panel of the screen.</para>
+
+ <para>Each step has one or more screens which may also have
+<guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> buttons with extra, less commonly required,
+options.</para>
+
+ <para>Most screens have <guibutton>Help</guibutton> buttons which give further
+explanations about the current step.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If somewhere during install you decide to stop the installation, it is
+possible to reboot, but please think twice before you do this. Once a
+partition has been formatted or updates have started to be installed, your
+computer is no longer in the same state and rebooting it could very well
+leave you with an unusable system. If in spite of this you are very sure
+rebooting is what you want, go to a text terminal by pressing the three keys
+<guibutton>Alt Ctrl F2</guibutton> at the same time. After that, press
+<guibutton>Alt Ctrl Delete</guibutton> simultaneously to reboot.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="installationProblems">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="installationProblems-ti1">Installation Problems and Possible Solutions</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <section xml:id="noX">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="noX-ti2">No Graphical Interface</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After the initial screen you did not reach the language selection
+screen. This can happen with some graphic cards and older systems. Try using
+low resolution by typing <code>vgalo</code> at the prompt.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="2">If the hardware is very old, a graphical installation may not be
+possible. In this case it is worth trying a text mode installation. To use
+this hit ESC at the first welcome screen and confirm with ENTER. You will be
+presented with a black screen with the word "boot:". Type "text" and hit
+ENTER. Now continue with the installation in text mode.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="installFreezes">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="installFreezes-ti1">The Install Freezes</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>If the system appeared to freeze during the installation, this may be a
+problem with hardware detection. In this case the automatic detection of
+hardware may be bypassed and dealt with later. To try this, type
+<code>noauto</code> at the prompt. This option may also be combined with
+other options as necessary.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="kernelOptions">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="kernelOptions-ti1">RAM problem</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>These will rarely be needed, but in some cases the hardware may report the
+available RAM incorrectly. To specify this manually, you can use the
+<code>mem=xxxM</code> parameter, where xxx is the correct amount of
+RAM. e.g. <code>mem=256M</code> would specify 256MB of RAM.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="DynamicPartitions">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="DynamicPartitions-ti1">Dynamic partitions</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>If you converted your hard disk from "basic" format to "dynamic" format on
+Microsoft Windows, you must know that it is impossible to install Mageia on
+this disc. To go back to a basic disk, see the Microsoft documentation:
+<link
+ns2:href="http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/cc776315.aspx">http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/cc776315.aspx</link>.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/login.xml b/docs/installer/ja/login.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..37db6376
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/login.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,24 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="login" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="label-to-adapt-ti1">Login screen</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject condition="live">
+ <imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="login-im1"
+format="PNG" fileref="live-login.png"/> </imageobject>
+
+ <caption>
+ <para>KDM login screen</para>
+ </caption>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Finally, you will come to the login screen.</para>
+
+ <para>Enter your user name and user password, and in a few seconds you will find
+yourself with a loaded KDE or GNOME desktop, depending on which live medium
+you used. You can now start using your Mageia installation.</para>
+
+ <para>You can find another part of our documentation in <link
+linkend="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Category:Documentation">the Mageia
+wiki</link>.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/media_selection.xml b/docs/installer/ja/media_selection.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..edd99ff9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/media_selection.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="media_selection" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="media_selection-ti1">Media Selection (Nonfree)</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!-- papoteur 2013-04-11 - created -->
+<!-- marja 2013-04-16 added screenshot + made title longer (because it was the same as for add_supplemental_media)-->
+<!-- marja 2013-04-16 s/in/during/ as suggested by Tristan Campbell -->
+<!--marja 2013-04-17 s/xml:id="media-selection"/xml:id="media_selection"/ (html filename was wrong)-->
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="dx2-media_selection.png"
+format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="media_selection-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here you have the list of available repositories. Not all repositories are
+available, according to which media you use for installing. The repositories
+selection determines which packages will be available for selection during
+the next steps.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The <emphasis>Core</emphasis> repository cannot be disabled as it contains
+the base of the distribution.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The <emphasis>Nonfree</emphasis> repository includes packages that are
+free-of-charge, i.e. Mageia may redistribute them, but they contain
+closed-source software (hence the name - Nonfree). For example this
+repository includes nVidia and ATI graphics card proprietary drivers,
+firmware for various WiFi cards, etc.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The <emphasis>Tainted</emphasis> repository includes packages released under
+a free license. The main criteria for placing packages in this repository is
+that they may infringe patents and copyright laws in some countries,
+e.g. Multimedia codecs needed to play various audio/video files; packages
+needed to play commercial video DVD, etc.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/minimal-install.xml b/docs/installer/ja/minimal-install.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a4073083
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/minimal-install.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="minimal-install"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+
+ <!--2012-12-26 marja - exported this section from choosePackages.xml to
+ start a new page-->
+<!--2013-05-05 marja - added screenshot and s/next/related/ -->
+<info>
+ <title xml:id="minimal-install-ti1">Minimal Install</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+ <para>You can choose a Minimal Installation by de-selecting everything in the
+Package Group Selection screen, see <xref
+linkend="choosePackageGroups"></xref>.</para>
+ <para>If desired, you can additionally tick the "Individual package selection"
+option in the same screen.</para>
+ <para>Minimal Installation is intended for those with specific uses in mind for
+their <application>Mageia</application>, such as a server or a specialised
+workstation. You will probably use this option combined with the "Individual
+package selection" option mentioned above, to fine-tune your installation,
+see <xref linkend="choosePackagesTree"></xref>.</para>
+ <para>If you choose this installation class, then the related screen will offer
+you a few useful extras to install, such as documentation and X.</para>
+ <para>If selected, "With X" will also include IceWM as lightweight desktop
+environment.</para>
+ <para>The basic documentation is provided in the form of man and info pages. It
+contains the man pages from the <link
+xlink:href="http://www.tldp.org/manpages/man.html">Linux Documentation
+Project</link> and the <link
+xlink:href="http://www.gnu.org/software/coreutils/manual/">GNU
+coreutils</link> info pages.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-minimal-install.png"
+align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="minimal-install-im1"></imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/misc-params.xml b/docs/installer/ja/misc-params.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8ebeaa0b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/misc-params.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,210 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="misc-params" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="misc-params-ti1">Summary of miscellaneous parameters</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Started by marja on 2012 03 31 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE WRITTEN AND REVIEWED! -->
+<!--marja - 2012 04 15 added some text, not much, unfortunately :( -->
+<!--marja 2012-04-24 added screenshots -->
+<!--JohnR 2012-04-25 Added text as requested by Psec :-)-->
+<!--marja 2012-04-24 added 2 links to other help pages -->
+<!--marja 2012-04-24 added some text in the drakxid-configureServices and
+ the drakxid-miscellaneous section -->
+<!--marja 2012-04-24 corrected "Magaia" in the last paragraph -->
+<!--marja 2012-04-24 corrected para xml:id number in the last paragraph -->
+<!-- 2012-05-01 marja - added You-Cheng Hsieh's section about IBus etc. -->
+<!-- 2012-08-09 marja - replaced linkend="setupBootloaderBeginner" by linkend="setupBootloader" -->
+<!--2012-12-25 marja - moved configureTimezoneUTC, selectCountry, configureServices and SecurityLevel out to separate files-->
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-summary.png" revision="1"
+align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="summary-im1" /> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-pa1">DrakX made smart choices for the configuration of your system depending on
+the choices you made and on the hardware DrakX detected. You can check the
+settings here and change them if you want after pressing
+<guibutton>Configure</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <section xml:id="misc-params-system">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="misc-params-system-ti2">System parameters</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-system-pa2" revision="1"><guilabel>Timezone</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-system-pa2a" revision="1">DrakX selected a time zone for you, depending on your preferred
+language. You can change it if needed. See also <xref
+linkend="configureTimezoneUTC"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-system-pa3" revision="1"><guilabel>Country / Region</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa3a">If you are not in the selected country, it is very important that you
+correct the setting. See <xref linkend="selectCountry"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-system-pa4" revision="1"><guilabel>Bootloader</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa4a">DrakX has made good choices for the bootloader setting.</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa4b">Do not change anything, unless you know how to configure Grub and/or Lilo</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa4c">For more information, see <xref linkend="setupBootloader"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa5"><guilabel>User management</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa5a">You can add extra users here. They will each get their own
+<literal>/home</literal> directories.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-system-pa6"><guilabel>Services</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-system-pa6a" revision="1">System services refer to those small programs which run the background
+(daemons). This tool allows you to enable or disable certain tasks.</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-system-pa6b" revision="1">You should check carefully before changing anything here - a mistake may
+prevent your computer from operating correctly.</para>
+
+ <para>For more information, see <xref linkend="configureServices"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="misc-params-hardware">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="misc-params-hardware-ti3">Hardware parameters</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa1"><guilabel>Keyboard</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa1a" revision="1">This is where you setup or change your keyboard layout which will depend on
+your location, language or type of keyboard.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa2"><guilabel>Mouse</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa2a">Here you can add or configure other pointing devices, tablets, trackballs
+etc.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa3"><guilabel>Sound card</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa3a">The installer uses the default driver, if there is a default one. The option
+to select a different driver is only given when there is more than one
+driver for your card, but none of them is the default one.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa4" revision="1"><guilabel>Graphical interface</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa4a">This section allows you to configure your graphic card(s) and displays.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-hardware-pa4b">For more information, see <xref linkend="configureX_chooser"/>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata xml:id="summaryBottom-im1" revision="1"
+align="center" format="PNG" fileref="dx2-summaryBottom.png" />
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="misc-params-network">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="misc-params-network-ti4">Network and Internet parameters</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-network-pa1"><guilabel>Network</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-network-pa2" revision="1">You can configure your network here, but for network cards with non-free
+drivers it is better to do that after reboot, in the <application>Mageia
+Control Center</application>, if you have not yet enabled the Nonfree media
+repositories.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-network-pa3" revision="1">When you add a network card, do not forget to set your firewall to watch
+that interface as well.</para>
+ </warning>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-network-pa4" revision="1"><guilabel>プロキシ</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-network-pa4a" revision="1">A Proxy Server acts as an intermediary between your computer and the wider
+internet. This section allows you to configure your computer to utilize a
+proxy service.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-network-pa4b">You may need to consult your systems administrator to get the parameters you
+need to enter here</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="misc-params-security">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="misc-params-security-ti5">セキュリティ</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-security-pa1" revision="1"><guilabel>Security Level</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-security-pa1a">Here you set the Security level for your computer, in most cases the default
+setting (Standard) is adequate for general use.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-security-pa1b">Check the option which best suits your usage.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-security-pa2" revision="1"><guilabel>Firewall</guilabel>:</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="misc-params-security-pa2a" revision="1">A firewall is intended to be a barrier between your important data and the
+rascals out there on the internet who would compromise or steal it.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-security-pa2b">Select the services that you wish to have access to your system. Your
+selections will depend on what you use your computer for.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="misc-params-security-pa2c">Bear in mind that allowing everything (no firewall) may be very risky.</para>
+ </warning>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/reboot.xml b/docs/installer/ja/reboot.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d99c53de
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/reboot.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="reboot" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="reboot-ti1">再起動</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject condition="live">
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="live-reboot.png"
+format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="reboot-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Once the bootloader has been installed, you will be prompted to halt your
+computer, remove the live CD and restart the computer. When you restart, you
+will see a succession of download progress bars. These indicate that the
+software media are being downloaded (see Software management).</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/resizeFATChoose.xml b/docs/installer/ja/resizeFATChoose.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ef24fd1f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/resizeFATChoose.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,33 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="resizeFATChoose">
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 31 -->
+<!--2013-12-01 re-adding this file to software/i18n/tools/docs/installer/en
+ in git, in case the related screen gets restored in drakx-installer-stage2-->
+<title xml:id="resizeFATChoose-ti1">Resize <application>Windows<superscript>®</superscript></application>
+partition</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="resizeFATChoose-pa1">You have more than one
+<application>Windows<superscript>®</superscript></application> partition.
+Choose which one should be made smaller to make space for installing
+<application>Mageia</application>.</para>
+
+
+
+<!--<para revision="1" xml:id="resizeFATChoose-pa2">
+.......</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="resizeFATChoose-pa3">........</para>-->
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/securityLevel.xml b/docs/installer/ja/securityLevel.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4d3b53eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/securityLevel.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xml:id="securityLevel" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="securityLevel-ti1">セキュリティレベル</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!-- 2012-12-25 marja - moved this part out of misc-params.xml" -->
+<!-- 2013-05-05 marja - added screenshot -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-securityLevel.png"
+align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="securityLevel-im1"></imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="securityLevel-pa1">You can adjust your security level here.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="securityLevel-pa2">Leave the default settings as they are, if you don't know what to choose.</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="securityLevel-pa3">After install, it will always be possible to adjust your security settings
+in the <guilabel>Security</guilabel> part of the Mageia Control Center.</para>
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/selectCountry.xml b/docs/installer/ja/selectCountry.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..48c9a720
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/selectCountry.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xml:id="selectCountry" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="selectCountry-ti1">Select your Country / Region</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+<mediaobject>
+<!-- 2012-12-25 marja - moved this section out of misc-params -->
+<!-- 2013-05-05 marja - added screenshot -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-selectCountry.png"
+align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="selectCountry-im1"></imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="selectCountry-pa1">Select your country or region. This is important for all kinds of settings,
+like the currency and wireless regulatory domain. Setting the wrong country
+can lead to not being able to use a Wireless network.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectCountry-pa2">If your country isn't in the list, click the <guilabel>Other
+Countries</guilabel> button and choose your country / region there.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectCountry-pa3">If your country is only in the <guilabel>Other Countries</guilabel> list,
+after clicking <guibutton>OK</guibutton> it may seem a country from the
+first list was chosen. Please ignore this, DrakX will follow your real
+choice.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <section xml:id="inputMethod">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="inputMethod-ti7">Input method</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectCountry-pa4">In the <guilabel>Other Countries</guilabel> screen you can also select an
+input method (at the bottom of the list). Input methods allow users to input
+multilingual characters (Chinese, Japanese, Korean, etc). IBus is the
+default input method in Mageia DVDs, Africa/India and Asia/no-India
+Live-CDs. For Asian and African locales, IBus will be set as default input
+method so users should not need to configure it manually. Other input
+methods(SCIM, GCIN, HIME, etc) also provide similar functions and can be
+installed if you added HTTP/FTP media before package selection.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectCountry-pa5">If you missed the input method setup during installation, you can access it
+after you boot your installed system via "Configure your Computer" -&gt;
+"System", or by running localedrake as root.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/selectInstallClass.xml b/docs/installer/ja/selectInstallClass.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1a36a837
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/selectInstallClass.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="selectInstallClass">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Made by marja on 2012 03 18 -->
+<!-- 20120405 updated JohnR -->
+<!-- enhanced xml code for screenshot, removed para xml:id's, changed "you'll" to
+ "you will" and "don't" to "do not" and a passive to an active tense, marja, 20120409-->
+<!-- barjac 2012-04-10 In the spirit of KISS reverted to my initial basic version -->
+<!-- 2013-05-05 marja, corrected typo in screenshot name, removed -->
+<title xml:id="selectInstallClass-ti1">Install or Upgrade</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-selectInstallClass.png" align="center"
+format="PNG"></imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>インストール</para>
+
+ <para>Use this option for a fresh <application>Mageia</application> installation.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Upgrade</para>
+
+ <para>If you have one or more <application>Mageia</application> installations on
+your system, the installer will allow you to upgrade one of them to the
+latest release.</para>
+
+<warning>
+ <para>Only upgrading from a previous Mageia version that was <emphasis>still
+supported</emphasis> when this installer's version was released, has been
+thoroughly tested. If you want to upgrade a Mageia version that had already
+reached its End Of Life when this one was released, then it is better to do
+a clean install while preserving your <literal>/home</literal> partition.</para>
+</warning>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If during install you decide to stop the installation, it is possible to
+reboot, but please think twice before you do this. Once a partition has been
+formatted or updates have started to be installed, your computer isn't in
+the same state anymore and rebooting it could very well leave you with an
+unusable system. If in spite of that you are very sure rebooting is what you
+want, go to a text terminal by pressing the three keys <guilabel>Alt Ctrl
+F2</guilabel> at the same time. After that, press <guilabel>Alt Ctrl
+Delete</guilabel> simultaneously to reboot.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <tip>
+ <para>If you have discovered that you forgot to select an additional language, you
+can return from the "Install or Upgrade" screen to the language choice
+screen by pressing <guilabel>Alt Ctrl Home</guilabel>. Do
+<emphasis>not</emphasis> do this later in the install.</para>
+ </tip>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboard.xml b/docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboard.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..76544e26
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboard.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,56 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="selectKeyboard"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Started by marja on 2012 03 31 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<title xml:id="selectKeyboard-ti1">キーボード</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectKeyboard-pa1">DrakX selects an appropriate keyboard for your language. If no suitable
+keyboard is found it will default to a US keyboard layout.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="dx2-selectKeyboard.png" />
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectKeyboard-pa2">Make sure that the selection is correct or choose another keyboard
+layout. If you don't know which layout your keyboard has, look in the
+specifications that came with your system, or ask the computer vendor. There
+may even be a label on the keyboard that identifies the layout. You can also
+look here: <link
+xlink:href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Keyboard_layout">en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Keyboard_layout</link></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectKeyboard-pa3">If your keyboard isn't in the list shown, click on
+<guibutton>More</guibutton> to get a full list, and select your keyboard
+there.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1"><warning>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectKeyboard-pa5">After choosing a keyboard from the <guibutton>More</guibutton> dialog,
+you'll return to the first keyboard choice dialog and it will seem as though
+a keyboard from that screen was chosen. You can safely ignore this anomaly
+and continue the installation: Your keyboard is the one you chose from the
+full list.</para>
+ </warning></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="selectKeyboard-pa4">If you choose a keyboard based on non-Latin characters, you will see an
+extra dialog screen asking how you would prefer to switch between the Latin
+and non-Latin keyboard layouts</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboardLive.xml b/docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboardLive.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..81e54a0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/selectKeyboardLive.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,14 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="selectKeyboardLive">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="selectKeyboardLive-ti1">Select keyboard</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata xml:id="selectKeyboardLive-im1" revision="1"
+align="center" format="PNG" fileref="live-selectKeyboard.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You will be required to set the keyboard layout you wish to use in
+Mageia​​. The default one is selected according to your language and
+timezone previously selected.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/selectLanguage.xml b/docs/installer/ja/selectLanguage.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..111645f9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/selectLanguage.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,63 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="selectLanguage" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Made by marja on 2012 04 01, using barjac's text -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- SimonNZG 2012-04-03 has had a look -->
+<!-- removed para id's, corrected duplicate id's for segments, corrected wrong
+ code in figure, marja, 20120409 -->
+<!-- barjac 2012-04-11 - removed image figure tag - and once again had to clean
+ up mess made of this header by xxe -->
+<title xml:id="selectLanguage-ti1">使用する言語を選んでください。</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>Select your preferred language, by first expanding the list for your
+continent. <application>Mageia</application> will use this selection during
+the installation and for your installed system.</para>
+
+ <para condition="classical">If it is likely that you will require several languages installed on your
+system, for yourself or other users, then you should use the
+<guibutton>Multiple languages</guibutton> button to add them now. It will be
+difficult to add extra language support after installation.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject condition="classical"> <imagedata align="center"
+fileref="dx2-selectLanguage.png" format="PNG"/> </imageobject> <imageobject
+condition="live"> <imagedata fileref="live-language.png" format=""/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <warning condition="classical">
+ <para>Even if you choose more than one language, you must first choose one of them
+as your preferred language in the first language screen. It will also be
+marked as chosen in the multiple languages screen .</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem condition="classical">
+ <para>If your keyboard language is not the same as your preferred language, then
+it is advisable to install the language of your keyboard as well.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Mageia uses UTF-8 (Unicode) support by default.</para>
+
+ <para condition="classical">This may be disabled in the "multiple languages" screen if you know that it
+is inappropriate for your language. Disabling UTF-8 applies to all installed
+languages.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You can change the language of your system after installation in the Mageia
+Control Center -> System -> Manage localization for your system.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/selectMouse.xml b/docs/installer/ja/selectMouse.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4e62fcbe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/selectMouse.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="selectMouse" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="selectMouse-ti1">Select mouse</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Made by marja on 2012 04 11 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- adding some "real" text now that we know the page shows up in the right place-->
+<!-- marja 2012-04-24 adding screenshot -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-selectMouse.png" align="center"
+format="PNG" > </imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="selectMouse-pa1">If you are not happy with how your mouse responds, you can select a
+different one here.</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="selectMouse-pa2">Usually, <guilabel>Universal</guilabel> - <guilabel>Any PS/2 and USB
+mice</guilabel> is a good choice.</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="selectMouse-pa3">Select <guilabel>Universal</guilabel> - <guilabel>Force evdev</guilabel> to
+configure the buttons that do not work on a mouse with six or more buttons.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/setupBootloader.xml b/docs/installer/ja/setupBootloader.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ce2852e8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/setupBootloader.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="setupBootloader">
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!---->
+<!--Lebarhon 2015 07 04 Project for Mageia 5. The UEFI and BIOS systems are so different I think it is better to split the page-->
+<title xml:id="setupBootloader-ti1">ブートローダのメインオプション</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" align="center"
+fileref="dx2-setupBootloader.png" xml:id="setupBootloader-im1"
+format="PNG"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>With a Bios system</title>
+
+ <para xml:id="setupBootloader-pa1" revision="4">If you prefer different bootloader settings to those chosen automatically by
+the installer, you can change them here.</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="setupBootloader-pa2" revision="4">You may already have another operating system on your machine, in which case
+you need to decide whether to add Mageia to your existing bootloader, or
+allow Mageia to create a new one.</para>
+
+ <tip>
+ <para>The Mageia graphical menus are nice :</para>
+ </tip>
+
+ <section xml:id="usingMageiaBootloader">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="usingMageiaBootloader-ti2">Using a Mageia bootloader</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="3" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa4">By default, Mageia writes a new GRUB (legacy) bootloader into the MBR
+(Master Boot Record) of your first hard drive. If you already have other
+operating systems installed, Mageia attempts to add them to your new Mageia
+boot menu.</para>
+
+ <para revision="3">Mageia now also offers GRUB2 as an optional bootloader in addition to GRUB
+legacy and Lilo.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para revision="3" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa6">Linux systems which use the GRUB2 bootloader are not currently supported by
+GRUB (legacy) and will not be recognized if the default GRUB bootloader is
+used.</para>
+
+ <para revision="3">The best solution here is to use the GRUB2 bootloader which is available at
+the Summary page during installation.</para>
+ </warning>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="usingExistingBootloader">
+ <info>
+ <title revision="2" xml:id="usingExistingBootloader-ti4">Using an existing bootloader</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="3" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa46">If you decide to use an existing bootloader then you will need to remember
+to STOP at the summary page during the installation and click the Bootloader
+<guibutton>Configure</guibutton> button, which will allow you to change the
+bootloader install location.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa47">Do not select a device e.g."sda", or you will overwrite your existing
+MBR. You must select the root partition that you chose during the
+partitioning phase earlier, e.g. sda7.</para>
+
+ <para xml:id="setupBootloader-pa48" revision="1">To be clear, sda is a device, sda7 is a partition on that device.</para>
+
+ <tip>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa48a">Go to tty2 with Ctrl+Alt+F2 and type <literal>df</literal> to check where
+your <literal>/</literal> (root) partition is. Ctrl+Alt+F7 takes you back to
+the installer screen.</para>
+ </tip>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa49">The exact procedure for adding your Mageia system to an existing bootloader
+is beyond the scope of this help, however in most cases it will involve
+running the relevant bootloader installation program which should detect and
+add it automatically. See the documentation for the operating system in
+question.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="advancedOptionBootloader">
+ <info>
+ <title revision="2" xml:id="advancedOptionBootloader-ti5">Bootloader advanced option</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para revision="3" xml:id="setupBootloader-pa52">If you have very limited disk space for the <literal>/</literal> partition
+that contains <literal>/tmp</literal>, click on
+<guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> and check the box for <guilabel>Clean /tmp
+at each boot</guilabel>. This helps to maintain some free space.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>With an UEFI system</title>
+
+ <para>With an UEFI system, the user interface is slightly different as you cannot
+choose the boot loader since only Grub2-efi is available. </para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-setupBootloader2.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If Mageia is the first system installed on your computer, the installer
+created an ESP (EFI System Partition) to receive the bootloader
+(Grub2-efi). If there was already UEFI operating systems previously
+installed on your computer (Windows 8 for example), the Mageia installer
+detected the existing ESP created by Windows and added grub2-efi. Although
+it is possible to have several ESPs, only one is advised and enough whatever
+the number of operating systems you have.</para>
+
+ <para>Don't modify the "Boot Device" unless really knowing what you do.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml b/docs/installer/ja/setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..88f1d1d8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/setupBootloaderAddEntry.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,64 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="setupBootloaderAddEntry" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!--Lebarhon 2015 07 04 Project for Mageia 5. The UEFI and BIOS systems are so different I think it is better to split the page-->
+<title xml:id="setupBootloaderAddEntry-ti1">Add or Modify a Boot Menu Entry</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1"
+fileref="dx2-bootloaderConfiguration.png" align="center" format="PNG"
+xml:id="bootloaderConfiguration-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>With a Bios system</title>
+
+ <para>You can add an entry or modify the one you select first, by pressing the
+relevant button in the <emphasis>Bootloader Configuration</emphasis> screen
+and editing the screen that pops up on top of it.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you have chosen <code>Grub 2</code> as your bootloader, you cannot use
+this tool to edit entries at this step, press 'Next'. You need to manually
+edit <code>/boot/grub2/custom.cfg</code> or use <code>grub-customizer</code>
+instead.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="setupBootloaderAddEntry-im1"
+align="center" format="PNG" fileref="dx2-setupBootloaderAddEntry.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Some things that can be done without any risk, are changing the label of an
+entry and ticking the box to make an entry the default one.</para>
+
+ <para>You can add the proper version number of an entry, or rename it completely.</para>
+
+ <para>The default entry is the one the systems boots into if you don't make a
+choice while booting up.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Editing other things can leave you with an unbootable system. Please don't
+just try something without knowing what you are doing.</para>
+ </warning>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>With an UEFI system</title>
+
+ <para>In this case you are using Grub2-efi and you cannot use this tool to edit
+entries at this step. To do that you need to manually edit
+<code>/boot/grub2/custom.cfg</code> or use <code>grub-customizer</code>
+instead. All you can do here, is to choose the default entry in the drop
+down list.</para>
+
+ <para>After a click on the <guibutton>Next</guibutton> button, another drop down
+list allows to choose the video resolution for Grub2 which is a graphical
+boot loader.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-bootloaderConfiguration2.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/setupSCSI.xml b/docs/installer/ja/setupSCSI.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..fa900477
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/setupSCSI.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xml:id="setupSCSI" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="setupSCSI-ti1">Setup SCSI</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Made by marja on 2012 04 02 -->
+<!-- NEEDS TO BE REVIEWED! -->
+<!-- JohnR - edited 2012-03-03 -->
+<!-- SimonNZG has reviewed 2012-04-03 (changed editted to edited in JohnR's comment ;-) -->
+<!-- barjac has re-reviewed and made some minor tweaks. Revisions incremented. -->
+<!-- marja 2012-04-24 added screenshot -->
+<!-- marja 2012-04-25 replacing John's version 1.6 because that one was based on the
+ Mdv doc instead of on our setupSCSI file -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata revision="1" fileref="dx2-setupSCSI.png"
+format="PNG" align="center" xml:id="setupSCSI-im1"></imagedata>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="3.1" xml:id="setupSCSI-pa1">DrakX usually detects hard disks correctly. With some older SCSI controllers
+it may be unable to determine the correct drivers to use and subsequently
+fail to recognise the drive.</para>
+
+ <para revision="2" xml:id="setupSCSI-pa2">If this happens, you will need to manually tell Drakx which SCSI drive(s)
+you have.</para>
+
+ <para revision="3" xml:id="setupSCSI-pa3">DrakX should then be able to configure the drive(s) correctly.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/soundConfig.xml b/docs/installer/ja/soundConfig.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3a376b68
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/soundConfig.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xml:id="soundConfig" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="soundConfig-ti1">サウンドの設定</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Started by marja on 2013-12-07 -->
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="dx2-soundConfig.png" revision="1"
+format="PNG" xml:id="soundConfig-im1" /> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen the name of the driver that the installer chose for your
+sound card is given, which will be the default driver if we have a default
+one.
+ </para>
+ <para>The default driver should work without problems. However, if after install
+you do encounter problems, then run <command>draksound</command> or start
+this tool via MCC (Mageia Control Center), by choosing the
+<guilabel>Hardware</guilabel> tab and clicking on <guilabel>Sound
+Configuration</guilabel> at the top right of the screen.
+ </para>
+ <para>Then, in the draksound or "Sound Configuration" tool screen, click on
+<guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> and then on
+<guibutton>Troubleshooting</guibutton> to find very useful advice about how
+to solve the problem.
+ </para>
+
+ <section xml:id="soundConfig-Advanced">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="soundConfig-Advanced-ti1">詳細</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>Clicking <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> in this screen, during install, is
+useful if there is no default driver and there are several drivers
+available, but you think the installer selected the wrong one.
+ </para>
+
+ <para>In that case you can select a different driver after clicking on
+<guibutton>Let me pick any driver</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/takeOverHdConfirm.xml b/docs/installer/ja/takeOverHdConfirm.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3c641394
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/takeOverHdConfirm.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,33 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns42="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="takeOverHdConfirm">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="takeOverHdConfirm-ti1">Confirm hard disk to be formatted</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<!-- Made by marja on 2012 04 03 -->
+<!-- test comment - johnr -->
+<!-- 2012-04-24 marja - replaced "if you are not sure you selected the correct
+ hard disk." with "if you are not sure about your choice", because I'm sure I
+ saw this help screen when I had only one HD -->
+<!-- 2013-05-05 marja added screenshot -->
+<imageobject condition='live'> <imagedata
+fileref="live-takeOverHdConfirm.png" format="PNG" align="center"
+></imagedata> </imageobject> <imageobject condition='classical'> <imagedata
+fileref="dx2-takeOverHdConfirm.png" format="PNG" align="center"
+></imagedata> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="takeOverHdConfirm-pa1">Click on <guibutton>Previous</guibutton> if you are not sure about your
+choice.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="takeOverHdConfirm-pa2">Click on <guibutton>Next</guibutton> if you are sure and want to erase every
+partition, every operating system and all data on that hard disk.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/testing.xml b/docs/installer/ja/testing.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..919b5f6b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/testing.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="testing" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="testing-ti1">Testing Mageia as Live system</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <section xml:id="testing-1">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="testing1-ti1">Live mode</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="live-liveMode.png"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You get this screen if you selected "Boot Mageia". If not, you get the
+"<link linkend="doPartitionDisks">Partitioning</link> step"</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="testing2-ti1">Testing hardware</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>One of the Live mode goals is to test if the hardware is correctly managed
+by Mageia. You can check if all devices have a driver in the Hardware
+section of the Mageia Control Center. You can test the most current devices:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>network interface: configure it with net_applet</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>graphical card: if you see the previous screen, it's already OK.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>webcam:</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>sound: a jingle has already been played</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>printer: configure it and print a test page</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>scanner: scan a document from ...</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>If all is OK for you, you can process to the installation. If not, you can
+leave with the quit button.</para>
+
+ <remark>The configuration settings you made here are kept for the installation.</remark>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="testing3-ti1">Launch installation</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="live-liveMode-install.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>To launch the installation of Mageia LiveCD or Live DVD to the hard disc or
+SSD drive, simply click on the icon "Install on Hard Disk". You will get
+this screen, and then the "<link
+linkend="doPartitionDisks">Partitioning</link> step" as for the direct
+installation.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/uninstall-Mageia.xml b/docs/installer/ja/uninstall-Mageia.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c4973b79
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/uninstall-Mageia.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="uninstall-Mageia">
+ <!--Lebarhon 2015-07-06 Not true with UEFI -->
+<info>
+ <title xml:id="uninstall-Mageia-ti1">Uninstalling Mageia</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="uninstall-Mageia-ti2">Howto</title>
+
+ <para>If Mageia didn't convince you or you can't install it correctly, in short
+you want get rid of it. That is your right and Mageia also gives you the
+possibility to uninstall. This is not true for every operating system.</para>
+
+ <para>After your data backup, reboot your installation Mageia DVD and select
+Rescue system, then, Restore Windows boot loader. At the next boot, you will
+only have Windows with no option to choose your operating system.</para>
+
+ <para>To recover the space used by Mageia partitions on Windows, click on
+<code>Start -> Control Panel -> Administrative Tools -> Computer Management
+-> Storage -> Disk Management</code> to access to the partition
+management. You will recognize the Mageia partition because they are labeled
+<guilabel>Unknown</guilabel>, and also by their size and place in the
+disk. Right click on each of these partitions and select
+<guibutton>Delete</guibutton>. The space will be freed.</para>
+
+ <para>If you are using Windows XP, you can create a new partition and format it
+(FAT32 or NTFS). It will get a partition letter.</para>
+
+ <para>If you have Vista or 7, you have one more possibility, you can extend the
+existing partition that is at the left of the freed space. There are other
+partitioning tools that can be used, such as gparted, available for both
+windows and linux. As always, when changing partitions, be very careful, and
+make sure all important things have been backed up.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/installer/ja/unused.xml b/docs/installer/ja/unused.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..e4783fe5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/installer/ja/unused.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="unused" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="unused-ti1">Keep or delete unused material</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject condition="live">
+<imageobject> <imagedata align="center" fileref="live-unused.png"
+format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="unused-im1"/> </imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this step, the installer looks for unused locales packages and unused
+hardware packages. Then it proposes you to delete them. It is a good idea to
+accept, except if you prepare an installation which has to run on different
+hardware.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+<imageobject> <imagedata fileref="live-unused-InstallationProgress.png"/>
+</imageobject></mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The next step is the copying of files on hard disk. This takes some
+minutes. At the end, you get a blank screen for some time, it's normal.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja.po b/docs/mcc-help/ja.po
index 418df323..9ed0c4a7 100644
--- a/docs/mcc-help/ja.po
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja.po
@@ -8,7 +8,7 @@ msgstr ""
"Project-Id-Version: Mageia\n"
"Report-Msgid-Bugs-To: doc-discuss@ml.mageia.org\n"
"POT-Creation-Date: 2016-02-26 22:38+0200\n"
-"PO-Revision-Date: 2016-04-25 08:06+0000\n"
+"PO-Revision-Date: 2016-05-24 15:28+0000\n"
"Last-Translator: Yuri Chornoivan <yurchor@ukr.net>\n"
"Language-Team: Japanese (http://www.transifex.com/MageiaLinux/mageia/"
"language/ja/)\n"
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC-cover.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC-cover.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2e93c75c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC-cover.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,62 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<!-- Converted by db4-upgrade version 1.0 -->
+<book xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude"
+ xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="MCC">
+
+ <info>
+ <title>Mageia コントロール センター</title>
+ <cover>
+ <para role="tagline">The tools to configure the Mageia system</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="mageia-2013.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+ <article>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-intro.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="software-management.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-sharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networkservices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-hardware.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-network.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-system.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networksharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-localdisks.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-security.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-boot.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="otherMageiaTools.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</article>
+</book>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b11852ef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/MCC.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?><!-- Converted by db4-upgrade version 1.0 -->
+<article xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="MCC">
+
+ <info>
+ <title>Mageia コントロール センター</title>
+ <cover>
+ <para xml:id="CC_BY-SA">The texts and screenshots in this manual are available under the CC BY-SA
+3.0 license <link
+ns6:href="http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/">http://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/3.0/</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>This manual was produced with the help of the <link
+ns6:href="http://www.calenco.com">Calenco CMS</link> developed by <link
+ns6:href="http://www.neodoc.biz">NeoDoc</link>.
+ </para>
+ <para>It was written by volunteers in their free time. Please contact <link
+ns6:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team">Documentation
+Team</link>, if you would like to help improve this manual.</para>
+ </cover>
+ </info>
+
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-intro.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="software-management.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-sharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networkservices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-hardware.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-network.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-system.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-networksharing.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-localdisks.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-security.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="mcc-boot.xml"></xi:include>
+
+<xi:include href="otherMageiaTools.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</article>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/MageiaUpdate.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/MageiaUpdate.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b476d899
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/MageiaUpdate.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,46 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="MageiaUpdate">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="MageiaUpdate-ti1">RPM のアップデート</title>
+
+ <subtitle>MageiaUpdate or drakrpm-update</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="MageiaUpdate-im1" align="center" fileref="MageiaUpdate.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">MageiaUpdate</emphasis> or <emphasis
+role="bold">drakrpm-update</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Software
+management.</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>To work, MageiaUpdate needs the repositories to be configured with
+drakrpm-editmedia with some media checked as updates. If they are not, you
+are prompted to do so.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para>As soon as this tool is launched, it scans the installed packages and lists
+those with an update available in the repositories. They are all selected by
+default to be automatically downloaded and installed. Click on the
+<guibutton>Update</guibutton> button to start the process.</para>
+
+ <para>By clicking on a package, more information is displayed in the lower half of
+the window. The print<emphasis role="bold"> ></emphasis> before a title
+means you can click to drop down a text.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>When updates are available, an applet in the system tray warns you by
+displaying this red icon <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="MageiaUpdate1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject>
+. Just click and enter the user password to update the system alike.</para>
+ </note></para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/XFdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/XFdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..89f996f0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/XFdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,129 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="XFdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="XFdrake-ti1">グラフィカルサーバを設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>XFdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="XFdrake-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="XFdrake.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool is present in the Mageia Control Center under the tab <emphasis
+role="bold">Hardware</emphasis>. Select <emphasis><guilabel>Set up the
+graphical server</guilabel></emphasis>. <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing
+<emphasis>XFdrake</emphasis> as normal user or <emphasis>drakx11</emphasis>
+as root. Mind the capital letters.</para>
+ </footnote></para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>The buttons allow you to change the graphical configuration.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Graphic card</emphasis>:</para>
+
+ <para>The graphic card currently detected is displayed and the matching server
+configured. Click on this button to change to another server, for example
+one with a proprietary driver.</para>
+
+ <para>The available servers are sorted under <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> by
+manufacturer in alphabetical order and then by model also in alphabetical
+order. The free drivers are sorted by alphabetical order under<guilabel>
+Xorg</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>In case of problems, <emphasis>Xorg - Vesa</emphasis> will work with most
+graphic cards and give you time to find and install the right driver while
+in your Desktop Environment.</para>
+
+ <para>If even Vesa doesn't work, choose <emphasis><guilabel>Xorg</guilabel> -
+<guilabel>fbdev</guilabel></emphasis>, which is used while installing
+Mageia, but doesn't allow you to change resolution or refresh rates.</para>
+ </note>If you made your choice for a free driver, you may be asked if you want to
+use a proprietary driver instead with more features (3D effects for
+example).</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Monitor:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>In the same way as above, the monitor currently detected is displayed and
+you can click on the button to change to another one. If the desired monitor
+isn't in the <guilabel>Vendor</guilabel> list, choose in the
+<guilabel>Generic</guilabel> list a monitor with the same features.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Resolution:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This button allows the choice of the resolution (number of pixels) and the
+colour depth (number of colours). It displays this screen:</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="XFdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>When you change the color depth, a
+multi-colored bar will appear next to the second button and show a preview
+of what the selected color depth looks like.</para>
+
+ <para>The first button shows the currently resolution, click to change for another
+one. The list gives all the possible choices according to the graphic card
+and the monitor, it is possible to click on <guilabel>Other</guilabel> to
+set other resolutions, but bear in mind that you can damage your monitor or
+select an uncomfortable setting.</para>
+
+ <para>The second button shows the currently colour depth, click to change this for
+another one.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>Depending on the chosen resolution, it may be necessary to logout and
+restart the graphical environment for the settings to take effect.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Test:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Once the configuration done, it is recommended to do a test before clicking
+on OK because it is easier to modify the settings now than later if the
+graphical environment doesn't work.</para>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>In case of a non working graphical environment, type Alt+Ctrl+F2 to open a
+text environment, connect as root and type XFdrake (with the caps) to to use
+XFdrake's text version.</para>
+ </note>If the test fails, just wait until the end, if it works but you don't want
+to change after all, click on <guibutton>No</guibutton>, if everything is
+right, click on <guibutton role="bold">OK</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>オプション:</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Global options</guilabel>: If <emphasis>Disable
+Ctrl-Alt-Backspace</emphasis> is checked, it will no longer be possible to
+restart X server using Ctrl+Alt+Backspace keys.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Graphic card options</guilabel>: Allows you to enable or disable
+three specific features depending on the graphic card.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>Graphical interface at startup</guilabel>: Most of the time,
+<emphasis>Automatically start the graphical interface (Xorg) upon
+booting</emphasis> is checked to make the boot switch to graphical mode, it
+may be unchecked for a server.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>After a click on the <guibutton>Quit</guibutton> button, the system will ask
+you to confirm. There is still time to cancel everything and keep the
+previous configuration, or to accept. In this case, you have to disconnect
+and reconnect to activate the new configuration.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--dav.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--dav.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..955aabe9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--dav.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="diskdrake--dav"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--dav-ti1">WebDAV 共有ドライブ/ディレクトリにアクセス</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --dav</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="diskdrake--dav1.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake--dav-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --dav</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found in the Mageia
+Control Center, under the Network Sharing tab, labeled <guilabel>Configure
+WebDAV shares</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para><link xlink:href="http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/WebDAV">WebDAV</link> is a
+protocol that allows to mount a web server's directory locally, so that it
+appears as a local directory. It is necessary that the remote machine run a
+WebDAV server. This is not the aim of this tool to configure the WebDAV
+server.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Creating a new entry</title>
+
+ <para>The first screen of the tool displays the already configured entries, if
+any, and a <guibutton>New</guibutton> button. Use it to create a new
+entry. Insert the server URL in the field of the new screen.</para>
+
+ <para>Then you get a screen with radio buttons to select some actions. Continue
+with the action <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> by clicking
+<guibutton>OK</guibutton> after selecting the radio button, as the
+<guibutton>Server</guibutton> is already configured. You can however correct
+it, if needed.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--dav3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The content of the remote directory will be accessible through this mount
+point.</para>
+
+ <para>In the next step, give your user name and password. If you need some other
+options, you can give them in the <guibutton>advanced</guibutton> screen.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--dav4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The option <guibutton>Mount</guibutton> allows you to mount immediately the
+access.</para>
+
+ <para>After you accepted the configuration with the radio button
+<guibutton>Done</guibutton>, the first screen is displayed again and your
+new mount point is listed. After you choose <guibutton>Quit</guibutton>, you
+are asked whether or not to save the modifications in
+<emphasis>/etc/fstab</emphasis>. Choose this option if you want that the
+remote directory is available at each boot. If your configuration is for
+one-time usage, do not save it.</para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--fileshare.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--fileshare.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a86fd464
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--fileshare.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="diskdrake--fileshare">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--fileshare-ti1">ハードディスクのパーティションを共有</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --fileshare</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--fileshare.png" revision="1" xml:id="diskdrake--fileshare-im1" align="center" format="PNG" />
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This simple tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --fileshare</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> allows you, the
+administrator, to allow users to share parts of their own /home
+subdirectories with other users of a same local network which may have
+computers running either Linux or Windows operating system.</para>
+
+ <para>It is found in the Mageia Control Center, under the Local Disk tab, labelled
+"Share your hard disk partitions".</para>
+
+ <para>First, answer the question : "<guilabel>Would you like to allow users to
+share some of their directories ?</guilabel>", click on <guibutton>No
+sharing</guibutton> if the answer is no for all users, click on
+<guibutton>Allow all users</guibutton> for all users and click on
+<guibutton>Custom</guibutton> if the answer is no for some users and yes for
+the others. In this last case, the users that are authorised to share their
+directories must belong to the fileshare group, which is automatically
+created by the system. You will be asked about this later.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on <guilabel>OK</guilabel>, a second screen appears which asks you
+choose between <guibutton>NFS</guibutton> or <guibutton>SMB</guibutton>.
+Check <guibutton>NFS</guibutton> if Linux is the only operating system on
+the network, check <guibutton>SMB</guibutton> if the network includes both
+Linux and Windows machines and then click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. Any
+required packages will be installed if necessary.</para>
+
+ <para>The configuration is now complete unless the Custom option was chosen. In
+this case, an extra screen prompts you to open Userdrake. This tool allows
+you to add users authorised to share their directories to the fileshare
+group. In the User tab, click on the user to add to the fileshare group,
+then on <guimenuitem>Edit</guimenuitem>, In the Groups tab. Check the
+fileshare group and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. For more information
+about Userdrake, see <link ns2:href="userdrake.xml">this page</link></para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>When adding a new user to the fileshare group, you have to disconnect and
+reconnect the network for the modifications to be taken into account.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>From now on each user belonging to the fileshare group can select in his/her
+file manager the directories to be shared, although not all file managers
+have this facility.</para>
+
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--nfs.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--nfs.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a87f4e09
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--nfs.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="diskdrake--nfs">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--nfs-ti1">NFS 共有ドライブ/ディレクトリにアクセス</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --nfs</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="2" xml:id="diskdrake--nfs-im1" align="center" fileref="diskdrake--nfs.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --nfs</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to declare some
+shared directories to be accessible to all users on the machine. The
+protocol used for this is NFS which is available on most Linux or Unix
+systems. The shared directory will be thus available directly at
+boot. Shared directories can be also accessible directly in a single session
+for a user with tools such as file browsers.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Procedure</title>
+
+ <para>Select <guibutton>search servers</guibutton> to obtain a list of servers
+which share directories.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on the > symbol before the server name to display the list of the
+shared directories and select the directory you want to access.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject ns2:href="diskdrake--nfs2.png">
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The button <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> will be available and you have
+to specify where to mount the directory.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject ns2:href="diskdrake--nfs3.png">
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>After choosing the mount point, You can mount it. You can also verify and
+change some options with the <guibutton>Options</guibutton> button. After
+mounting the directory, you can unmount it with the same button.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>On accepting the configuration with the <guibutton>Done</guibutton> button,
+a message will displayed, asking "Do you want to save the /etc/fstab
+modifications". This will make the directory available at each boot, if the
+network is accessible. The new directory is then available in your file
+browser, for example in Dolphin.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--nfs6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--removable.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--removable.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4af96c9d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--removable.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,52 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="diskdrake--removable">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--removable-ti1">CD/DVD burner</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --removable</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="diskdrake--removable.png" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="diskdrake--removable-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --removable</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote>is found under the tab Local
+disks in the Mageia Control Center labelled accordingly with your removable
+hardware (CD/DVD players and burners and floppy drives only). </para>
+
+ <para>Its goal is to define the way your removable disk is mounted. </para>
+
+ <para>At the top of the window there is a short description of your hardware and
+the chosen options to mount it. Use the menu on the bottom to change
+them. Check the item to be changed and then on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton>
+button. </para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>マウントポイント</title>
+
+ <para>Check this box to change the mount point. The default one is /media/cdrom.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>オプション</title>
+
+ <para>Many mount options can be chosen here either directly in the list or via the
+<guilabel>Advanced</guilabel> submenu. The main are:</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>user/nouser</title>
+
+ <para>user allows an ordinary user (not root) to mount the removable disk, this
+option involves noexec, nosuid and nodev. The user who mounted the disk is
+the only one who can umount it. </para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--smb.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--smb.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..16b4efab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/diskdrake--smb.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,89 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="diskdrake--smb"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="diskdrake--smb-ti1">Windows (Samba) 共有ドライブ/ディレクトリにアクセス</title>
+
+ <subtitle>diskdrake --smb</subtitle>
+
+ </info>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake --smb</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to declare which
+shared directories to be accessible to all users on the machine. The
+protocol used for this is SMB which has been popularized on Windows(R)
+systems. The shared directory will be available directly at boot. Shared
+directories can be also accessed directly in a single session by a user with
+tools such as file browsers.</para>
+
+ <para>Before starting the tool, it is a good idea to declare the names of
+available servers, for example with <xref linkend="drakhosts"/></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Procedure</title>
+
+ <para>Select <guibutton>search servers</guibutton> to obtain a list of servers who
+share directories.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on the server name and on &gt; before the server name to display the
+list of the shared directories and select the directory you want to access.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Mount point</guibutton> button will become available, you
+have to specify where to mount the directory.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>After choosing the mount point, it can be mounted with the <guimenu>Mount
+button</guimenu>. You can also verify and change some options with the
+<guibutton>Options</guibutton> button.</para>
+
+ <para>In options, you can specify the user name and the password of those able to
+connect to the SMB server. After mounting the directory, you can unmount it
+with the same button.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>After accepting the configuration with the Done button, a message will ask
+"Do you want to save the /etc/fstab modifications". Saving, will allow
+directory to made available at each boot, if the network is accessible. The
+new directory is then available in your file browser, for example in
+dolphin.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="diskdrake--smb5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drak3d.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drak3d.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f04776dd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drak3d.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drak3d" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drak3d-ti1">3D Desktop Effects</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drak3d</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drak3d-im1" revision="1" align="center" fileref="drak3d.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drak3d</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> lets you manage the 3D
+desktop effects on your operating system. 3D effects are turned off by
+default.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section annotations="center">
+ <title>Getting Started</title>
+
+ <para>To use this tool, you need to have the glxinfo package installed. If the
+package is not installed, you will be prompted to do so before drak3d can
+start.</para>
+
+ <para>After starting drak3d, you will be presented with a menu window. Here you
+can choose either <guilabel>No 3D Desktop Effects</guilabel> or
+<guilabel>Compiz Fusion</guilabel>. Compiz Fusion is part of a
+composite/window manager, which includes hardware-accelerated special
+effects for your desktop. Choose <guilabel>Compiz Fusion</guilabel> to turn
+it on.</para>
+
+ <para>If this is your first time using this program after a clean installation of
+Mageia, you will get a warning message telling you which packages need to be
+installed in order to use Compiz Fusion. Click on the
+<guibutton>Ok</guibutton> button to continue.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drak3d-im3" fileref="drak3d_installing_CompizFusion.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Once the appropriate packages are installed, you will notice that Compiz
+Fusion is selected in the drak3d menu, but you must log out and log back in
+for the changes to take effect.</para>
+
+ <para>After logging back in, Compiz Fusion will be activated. To configure Compiz
+Fusion, see the page for the ccsm (CompizConfig Settings Manager) tool.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>トラブルシューティング</title>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Can't See Desktop after Logging in</title>
+
+ <para>If after turning on Compiz Fusion you attempt to log back into your desktop
+but can't see anything, restart your computer to get back to the log in
+screen. Once there, click on the Desktop icon and select drak3d.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drak3d_troubleshooting_login_option.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>When you log in, if your account is listed as an administrator, you will be
+prompted for your password again. Otherwise, use the administrator login
+with his/her account. Then you can undo any changes that may have caused the
+log in problem.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakauth.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakauth.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..872d2e92
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakauth.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,29 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakauth" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakauth-ti1">認証</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakauth</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakauth.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakauth-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakauth</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> enables you to modify the
+manner in which you can be recognized as user of the machine or on the net.</para>
+
+ <para>By default, information for your authentication is stored in a file on your
+computer. Modify it only if your network administrator invites you to do so
+and give information about that.</para>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakautologin.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakautologin.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..876f9990
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakautologin.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakautologin">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakautologin-ti1">自動ログインを設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakautologin</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakautologin-im1" fileref="drakautologin.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakautologin</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to automatically
+login the same user, in her/his desktop environment, without asking for any
+password. It's called autologin. This is generally a good idea when there
+is only one user like to be using the machine.</para>
+
+ <para>It is found under the <emphasis role="bold">Boot</emphasis> tab in the
+Mageia Control Center labelled "Set up autologin to automatically log in".</para>
+
+ <para>The interface buttons are pretty obvious:</para>
+
+ <para>Check <guibutton>Launch the graphical environment when your system
+starts</guibutton>, if you want X Window System to be executed after the
+boot. If not, the system will start in text mode. Nevertheless, it will be
+possible to launch the graphic interface manually. This can be done by
+launching the command 'startx' or 'systemctl start dm'.</para>
+
+ <para>If the first box is checked, two other options are available, check either
+<guibutton>No, I don't want autologin</guibutton>, if you want the system to
+continue to ask for which user to connect (and password) or check
+<guibutton>Yes, I want autologin with this (user, desktop)</guibutton>, if
+needed. In this case, you also need to supply the <guilabel>Default
+username</guilabel> and the <guilabel>Default desktop</guilabel>.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakboot.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakboot.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..00ea47aa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakboot.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,170 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakboot" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakboot-ti1">起動システムを設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakboot</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata format="PNG" xml:id="drakboot--boot-im1" align="center" fileref="drakboot--boot.png" revision="1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If you are using a UEFI system instead of BIOS, the user interface is
+slightly different as you cannot choose the boot loader (first drop down
+list) since only one is available.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot--boot2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakboot</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to configure the
+boot options (choice of the bootloader, set a password, the default boot,
+etc.)</para>
+
+ <para>It is found under the Boot tab in the Mageia Control Center labeled "Set up
+boot system".</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Don't use this tool if you don't know exactly what you are doing. Changing
+some settings may prevent your machine from booting again !</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>In the first part, called <guilabel>Bootloader</guilabel>, it is possible if
+using BIOS, to choose which <guibutton>Bootloader to use</guibutton>, Grub,
+Grub2 or Lilo, and with a graphical or a text menu. It is just a question
+of taste, there are no other consequences. You can also set the
+<guibutton>Boot device</guibutton>, don't change anything here unless you
+are an expert. The boot device is where the bootloader is installed and any
+modification can prevent your machine from booting.</para>
+
+ <para>In UEFI system, the bootloader is <guilabel>Grub2-efi</guilabel> and is
+installed in /boot/EFI partition. This FAT32 formatted partition is common
+to all operating systems installed.</para>
+
+ <para>In the second part, called <guilabel>Main options</guilabel>, you can set
+the <guibutton>Delay before booting default image</guibutton>, in
+seconds. During this delay, Grub or Lilo will display the list of available
+operating systems, prompting you to make your choice. If no selection is
+made, the bootloader will boot the default one once the delay elapses.</para>
+
+ <para>In the third and last part, called <guibutton>Security</guibutton>, it is
+possible to set a password.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button gives some extra options.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable ACPI:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>ACPI (Advanced Configuration and Power Interface) is a standard for the
+power management. It can save energy by stopping unused devices, this was
+the method used before APM. Check this box if your hardware is ACPI
+compatible.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable SMP:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>SMP stands for Symmetric Multi Processors, it's an architecture for
+multicore processors.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you have a processor with HyperThreading, Mageia will see it as a dual
+processor and enable SMP.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable APIC</guibutton> and <guibutton>Enable Local
+APIC:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>APIC stands for Advanced Programmable Interrupt Controller. There are two
+components in the Intel APIC system, the local APIC (LAPIC) and the I/O
+APIC. The latter one routes the interrupts it receives from peripheral buses
+to one or more local APICs that are in the processor. It is really useful
+for multi-processor systems. Some computers have problems with the APIC
+system which can cause freezes or incorrect device detection (error message
+"spurious 8259A interrupt: IRQ7"). In this case, disable APIC and/or Local
+APIC.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Next</guibutton> screen differs depending on whether you have
+an <emphasis>BIOS</emphasis> or <emphasis>UEFI</emphasis> system.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You have a <emphasis>BIOS</emphasis> system:</para>
+
+ <para>In this case, you can see the list of all the available entries at boot
+time. The default one is asterisked. To change the order of the menu
+entries, click on the up or down arrows to move the selected item. If you
+click on the <guibutton>Add</guibutton> or <guibutton>Modify</guibutton>
+buttons, a new window appears to add a new entry in the bootloader menu or
+to modify an existing one. You need to be familiar with Lilo or Grub to be
+able to use these tools.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Label</guilabel> field is freeform, write here what you want
+to be displayed in the menu. It matches the Grub command "title". For
+example: Mageia3.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Image</guilabel> field contains the kernel name. It matches
+the Grub command "kernel". For example /boot/vmlinuz.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Root</guilabel> field contains the device name where the
+kernel is stored. It matches the Grub command "root". For example (hd0,1).</para>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Append</guilabel> field contains the options to be given to
+the kernel at boot time.</para>
+
+ <para>If the box <guilabel>Default</guilabel> is checked, Grub will boot this
+entry by default.</para>
+
+ <para>In the extra screen called <guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>, it is possible to
+choose the <guilabel>Video mode</guilabel>, an <guilabel>initrd</guilabel>
+file and a <guilabel>network profile</guilabel>, see <xref
+linkend="draknetprofile"/>, in the drop-down lists.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You have a <emphasis>UEFI</emphasis> system:</para>
+
+ <para>In this case, the drop-down list displays all the available entries; click
+on the one wanted as the default one.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakboot3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The <guilabel>Append</guilabel> field contains the options to be given to
+the kernel at boot time.</para>
+
+ <para>In the extra screen called <guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>, it is possible to
+choose the <guilabel>Video mode</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <para>To set many other parameters, you can use <emphasis>Grub
+Customizer</emphasis>, available in the Mageia repositories (see below).</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xreflabel="titi" fileref="drakboot4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a3892702
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section
+xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakbug" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakbug-ti1">Mageia Bug Report Tool</title><subtitle>drakbug</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakbug-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"
+ fileref="drakbug.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Usually, this tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakbug</emphasis>.</para></footnote> starts automatically
+when a Mageia tool crashes. However, it is also possible that, after filing
+a bug report, you are asked to start this tool to check some of the
+information it gives, and then provide that in that existing bug report.</para>
+
+ <para>If a new bug report needs to be filed and you are not used to doing that,
+then please read <link
+xlink:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/How_to_report_a_bug_properly">How to
+report a bug report properly</link> before clicking on the "Report" button.</para>
+
+ <para>In case the bug has already been filed by someone else (the error message
+that drakbug gave will be the same, then), it is useful to add a comment to
+that existing report that you saw the bug, too.</para>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug_report.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug_report.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8330f8f9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakbug_report.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section
+xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xml:id="drakbug_report" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakbug_report-ti1">Collect Logs and System Information for Bug Reports</title><subtitle>drakbug_report</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakbug_report</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can only be started and used
+on the command line.</para>
+
+<para>It is advised to write the output of this command to a file, for instance by
+doing <emphasis role="bold">drakbug_report > drakbugreport.txt</emphasis>,
+but make sure you have enough disk space first: the file can easily be
+several GBs large.</para>
+<note><para>The output is far too large to attach to a bug report without first removing
+the unneeded parts.</para></note>
+ <para>This command collects the following information on your system:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem><para> lspci</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> pci_devices</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> dmidecode</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> fdisk</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> scsi</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> /sys/bus/scsi/devices</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> lsmod</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> cmdline</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> pcmcia: stab</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> usb</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> partitions</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> cpuinfo</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> syslog</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> Xorg.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> monitor_full_edid</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> stage1.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> ddebug.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> install.log</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> fstab</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> modprobe.conf</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> lilo.conf</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> grub: menu.lst</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> grub: install.sh</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> grub: device.map</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> xorg.conf</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> urpmi.cfg</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> modprobe.preload</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> sysconfig/i18n</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> /proc/iomem</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> /proc/ioport</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> mageia version</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> rpm -qa</para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para> df</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+
+ <note><para>At the time this help page was written, the "syslog" part of this command's
+output was empty, because this tool had not yet been adjusted to our switch
+to systemd. If it is still empty, you can retrieve the "syslog" by doing (as
+root) <emphasis role="bold"> journalctl -a > journalctl.txt</emphasis>. If
+you don't have a lot of diskspace, you can, for instance, take the last 5000
+lines of the log instead with: <emphasis role="bold">journalctl -a | tail
+-n5000 > journalctl5000.txt</emphasis>.</para></note>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakclock.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakclock.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c3f7911c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakclock.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakclock">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakclock-ti1">日付と時間の管理</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakclock</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakclock.png" xml:id="drakclock-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakclock</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the tab System
+in the Mageia Control Center labelled <guilabel>"Manage date and
+time"</guilabel>. In some desktop environments it is also available by a
+right click / Adjust date and Time ... on the clock in the system tray.</para>
+
+ <para>It's a very simple tool.</para>
+
+ <para>On the upper left part, is the <emphasis role="bold">calendar</emphasis>. On
+the screenshot above, the date is September (on the upper left), 2012 (on
+the upper right), the 2nd (in blue) and it is a Sunday. Select the month
+(or year) by clicking on the little arrows on each side of September (or
+2012). Select the day by clicking on its number.</para>
+
+ <para>On the bottom left is the <emphasis role="bold">Network Time
+Protocol</emphasis> synchronising, it is possible to have a clock always on
+time by synchronising it with a server. Check <guilabel>Enable Network Time
+Protocol</guilabel> and choose the closest server.</para>
+
+ <para>On the right part is the <emphasis role="bold">clock</emphasis>. It's
+useless to set the clock if NTP is enabled. Three boxes display hours,
+minutes and seconds (15, 28 and 22 on the screenshot). Use the little arrows
+to set the clock to the correct time. The format can't be changed here, see
+your desktop environment settings for that.</para>
+
+ <para>At least, on the bottom right, select your time zone by clicking on the
+<guibutton>Change Time Zone</guibutton> button and choosing in the list the
+nearest town.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Even if it isn't possible to choose a date or time format in this tool, they
+will be displayed on your desktop in accordance with the localisation
+settings.</para>
+ </note>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect--del.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect--del.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b2ed3df7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect--del.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,18 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakconnect--del" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakconnect--del-ti1">接続を削除</title><subtitle>drakconnect --del</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakconnect--del-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakconnect--del.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here, you can delete a network interface<footnote><para>You can also start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakconnect --del</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote>.</para>
+ <para>Click on the drop down menu, choose the one you want to remove and then
+click <emphasis>next</emphasis>.</para>
+ <para>You'll see a message that the network interface has been deleted
+successfully.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..921a4367
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconnect.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,808 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakconnect">
+ <info annotations="simonnzg listened to Aicha by Khaled &amp; Faudel whilst editing this document.">
+ <title xml:id="drakconnect-ti1">新しいネットワークインターフェースを設定 (LAN, ISDN, ADSL など)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakconnect</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakconnect-im1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakconnect.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakconnect</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows to configure much of
+local network or Internet access. You have to know some information from
+your access provider or your network administrator.</para>
+
+ <para>Select the type of connection you want to set, according to which hardware
+and provider you have.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Wired connection (Ethernet)</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The first window lists the interfaces which are available. Select the one
+to configure.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this point, the choice is given between an automatic or a manual IP
+address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Automatic IP</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Ethernet/IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers
+are declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained
+below. In the last case, the IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified,
+the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.
+The Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option
+<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>. Not all DHCP servers
+have such a function and if you're setting up your PC to get an IP address
+from a domestic ADSL router, it is unlikely.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the DHCP client</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>DHCP timeout</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS server</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server
+requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP
+address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After accepting, the last steps which are common to all connection
+configurations are explained: <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>手動設定</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Ethernet/IP settings</emphasis>: you need to declare what DNS
+servers to use. The HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no
+HOSTNAME is specified, the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is
+attributed by default.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the IP address usually looks like
+<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is
+<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are
+available from your service provider's website.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search
+domain</emphasis>. It would usually be your home domain, i.e. if your
+computer is called "splash", and it's full domain name is
+"splash.boatanchor.net", the Search Domain would be "boatanchor.net". Unless
+you specifically need it, it's ok not to define this setting. Again,
+domestic ADSL would not need this setting.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect30.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Satellite connection (DVB)</title>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Cable modem connection</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The first window lists the interfaces which are available. Select the one
+to configure.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this point, the choice is given between an automatic or a manual IP
+address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>You have to specify a authentication method:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>なし</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>BPALogin (necessary for Telstra). In this case you have to provide User name
+and password.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Automatic IP</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Cable/IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers
+are declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained
+below. In the last case, the IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified,
+the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.
+The Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option
+<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis>. Not all DHCP servers
+have such a function and if you're setting up your PC to get an IP address
+from a domestic ADSL router, it is unlikely.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the DHCP client</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>DHCP timeout</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS server</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server
+requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP
+address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After accepting, the last steps which are common to all connection
+configurations are explained: <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>手動設定</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Cable/IP settings</emphasis>: you need to declare what DNS servers
+to use. The HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME
+is specified, the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is
+attributed by default.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the IP address usually looks like
+<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is
+<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are
+available from your service provider's website.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search
+domain</emphasis>. It would usually be your home domain, i.e. if your
+computer is called "splash", and it's full domain name is
+"splash.boatanchor.net", the Search Domain would be "boatanchor.net". Unless
+you specifically need it, it's ok not to define this setting. Again,
+domestic connection would not need this setting.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect32.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new DSL connection</title>
+
+ <para><orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the tool detects network interfaces, it offers to select one and to
+configure it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select one of the protocols available:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>手動による TCP/IP 設定</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PPP over ADSL (PPPoA)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PPP over Ethernet (PPPoE)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Point to Point Tunneling Protocol (PPTP)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>アクセスの設定</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>アカウントのログイン (ユーザ名)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Account password</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>(Advanced) Virtual Path ID (VPI)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>(Advanced) Virtual Circuit ID (VCI)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new ISDN connection</title>
+
+ <para><orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard asks which device to configure:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Manual choice (internal ISDN card)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>外付 ISDN モデム</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of hardware is proposed, classified by category and
+manufacturer. Select your card.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select one of the protocols available:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Protocol for the rest of the world, except Europe (DHCP)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Protocol for Europe (EDSS1)</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is then offered, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave
+you. Then it is asked for parameters:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>接続名</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>電話番号</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>ログイン ID</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Account password</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>認証方法</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After that, you have to select if you get the IP address by automatic or
+manual method. In the last case, specify IP address and Subnet mask.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next step is to choose how DNS servers address are obtained, by
+automatic or manual method. In the case of manual configuration, you have to
+put:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>ドメイン名</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>First and second DNS Server</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select if the hostname is set from IP. This option is to select only if you
+are sure that your provider is configured to accept it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next step is to choose how the gateway address is obtained, by automatic
+or manual method. In the case of manual configuration, you have to enter the
+IP address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Wireless connection (WiFi)</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A first window lists the interfaces which are available and an entry for
+Windows driver (ndiswrapper). Select the one to configure. Use ndiswrapper
+only if the other configuration methods did not work.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this step, the choice is given between the different access points that
+the card has detected.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Specific parameter for the wireless card are to provide:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect31.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Operating mode:</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Managed</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>To access to an existing access point (the most frequent).</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>Ad-Hoc</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>To configure direct connection between computers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Network Name (ESSID)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Encryption mode: it depends of how the access point is configured.</para>
+
+ <variablelist>
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>WPA/WPA2</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>This encryption mode is to prefer if your hardware allows it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+
+ <varlistentry>
+ <term>WEP</term>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Some old hardware deals only this encryption method.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </varlistentry>
+ </variablelist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>暗号鍵</para>
+
+ <para>It is generally provided with the hardware which give the access point.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>At this step, the choice is given between an automatic IP address or a
+manual IP address.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Automatic IP</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>IP settings</emphasis>: you have to select if DNS servers are
+declared by the DHCP server or are manually specified, as explained
+below. In the last case, IP address of DNS servers has to be set. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is
+specified, the name localhost.localdomain is attributed by default. The
+Hostname can also be provided by the DHCP server with the option
+<emphasis>Assign host name from DHCP server</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The advanced button give the opportunity to specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Search domain (not accessible, as provided by the DHCP server)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the DHCP client</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>DHCP timeout</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get YP server from DHCP (checked by default): specify the NIS servers</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Get NTPD server from DHCP (synchronisation of clocks)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the HOSTNAME required by DHCP. Only use this option if the DHCP server
+requires the client to specify a hostname before receiving an IP
+address. This option is not dealt by some DHCP servers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>After accepting the configuration the step, which is common to all
+connection configurations, is explained: <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>手動設定</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>IP settings</emphasis>: you have to declare DNS servers. The
+HOSTNAME of the computer can be specified here. If no HOSTNAME is specified,
+the name <literal>localhost.localdomain</literal> is attributed by default.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the IP address always looks like
+<emphasis>192.168.x.x</emphasis>, Netmask is
+<emphasis>255.255.255.0</emphasis>, and the Gateway and DNS servers are
+available from your providers website.</para>
+
+ <para>In advanced settings, you can specified a <emphasis>Search
+domain</emphasis>. It must seem to your hostname without the first name,
+before the period.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new GPRS/Edge/3G connection</title>
+
+ <para><orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the tool detects wireless interfaces, it offers to select one and to
+configure it.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The PIN is asked. Leave empty if the PIN is not required.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard asks for network. If it is not detected, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider gave.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Provide access settings</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>アクセスポイント名</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>アカウントのログイン (ユーザ名)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Account password</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Bluetooth Dial-Up Networking connection</title>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>A new Analog telephone modem connection (POTS)</title>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard asks which device to configure:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>手動選択</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Detected hardware, if any.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of ports is proposed. Select your port.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If not yet installed, it will be suggested that you install the package
+<emphasis>kppp-provider</emphasis>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>A list of providers is proposed, classified by countries. Select your
+provider. If it is not listed, select the option
+<guilabel>Unlisted</guilabel> and then enter the options your provider
+gave. Then it is asked for Dialup options:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Connection name</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Phone number</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Login ID</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Password</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Authentication</emphasis>, choose between:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PAP/CHAP</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>スクリプトを使う認証</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>PAP</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>ターミナルからの認証</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>CHAP</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The next steps are exposed at <xref linkend="drakconnect-end"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakconnect-end">
+ <title>Ending the configuration</title>
+
+ <para>In the next step, you can specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Allow users to manage the connection</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Start the connection at boot</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Enable traffic accounting</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Allow interface to be controlled by Network Manager</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>In the case of a wireless connection, a supplemental box is <emphasis>Allow
+access point roaming</emphasis> which give the possibility to switch
+automatically between access point according to the signal strength.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>With the advanced button, you can specify:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Metric (10 by default)</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>MTU</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Network Hotplugging</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>IPv6 to IPv4 トンネルを有効にする</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The last step allows you to specify if the connection is to start
+immediately or not.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakconnect9.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconsole.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconsole.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0bff7ff4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakconsole.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakconsole">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakconsole-ti1">管理者権限でコンソールを開く</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakconsole</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakconsole-im1" fileref="drakconsole.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakconsole</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> gives you access to a console
+which is directly opened as root. We do not think that you need more
+information about that.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakdisk.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakdisk.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0cd67b39
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakdisk.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakdisk">
+
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakdisk-ti1">ディスクパーティションを管理</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakdisk or diskdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakdiskBackup-im1" revision="1" fileref="drakdiskBackup.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakdisk</emphasis> or <emphasis
+role="bold">diskdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is very powerful, a tiny
+error or a cat jumping on your keyboard can lead to losing all data on a
+partition or even to erasing the entire hard disk. For that reason, you'll
+see the screen above on top of the tool screen. Click on
+<emphasis>Exit</emphasis> if you're not sure you want to continue.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>If you have more than one hard disk, you can switch to the hard disk you
+want to work on by selecting the correct tab (sda, sdb, sdc etc).</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="drakdisk-im1" fileref="drakdisk.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You can choose from many actions to adjust your hard disk to your
+preferences. Wiping an entire hard disk, splitting or merging partitions,
+resizing them or changing the filesystem, formatting or viewing what is in a
+partition: it is all possible. The <emphasis><guibutton>Clear
+all</guibutton></emphasis> button at the bottom is to erase the complete
+disk, the other buttons become visible on the right after you click on a
+partition.</para>
+
+
+
+ <!-- 2015-07-06 Note added by Lebarhon -->
+<note>
+ <para>If you have an UEFI system, you can see a small partition called "EFI System
+Partition" and mounted on /boot/EFI. Never delete it, because it contains
+all your different operating systems bootloaders.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>If the selected partition is mounted, like in the example below, you cannot
+choose to resize, format or delete it. To be able to do that the partition
+must be unmounted first.</para>
+
+ <para>It is only possible to resize a partition on its right side</para>
+
+ <para>To change a partition type (change ext3 to ext4 for example) you have to
+delete the partition and then re-create it with the new type. The button
+<guibutton role="bold">Create</guibutton> appears when a disk empty part is
+selected</para>
+
+ <para>You can choose a mount point that doesn't exist, it will be created.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakdiskMountedPartition-im1" revision="1" fileref="drakdiskMountedPartition.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Selecting <emphasis><guibutton>Toggle to expert mode</guibutton></emphasis>
+gives some extra available actions, like labeling the partition, as can be
+seen in the screenshot below.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakdiskExpertUnmounted-im1" align="center" fileref="drakdiskExpertUnmounted.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakedm.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakedm.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3e468f66
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakedm.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,27 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakedm" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+
+
+ <!--2012-09-03 marja: changed title to the title of this screen in MCC -->
+<title xml:id="drakedm-ti1">ディスプレイマネージャの設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakedm</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakedm-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakedm.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="drakedm-pa1">Here<footnote>
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="drakedm-pa3">You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakedm</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> you can choose which display
+manager to use to log into your desktop environment. Only the ones available
+on your system will be shown.</para>
+
+ <para revision="1" xml:id="drakedm-pa2">Most users will only notice that the provided login screens look
+different. However, there are differences in supported features, too. LXDM
+is a lightweight display manager, KDM and GDM have more extras.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfirewall.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfirewall.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..928eb2ee
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfirewall.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakfirewall" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakfirewall-ti1">個人用ファイアウォールの設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakfirewall</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="drakfirewall.png" align="center" xml:id="drakfirewall-im1" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakfirewall</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the Security
+tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled "Set up your personal
+firewall". It is the same tool in the first tab of "Configure system
+security, permissions and audit".</para>
+
+ <para>A basic firewall is installed by default with Mageia. All the incoming
+connections from the outside are blocked if they aren't authorised. In the
+first screen above, you can select the services for which outside connection
+attempts are accepted. For your security, uncheck the first box -
+<guilabel>Everything (no firewall)</guilabel> - unless you want to disable
+the firewall, and only check the needed services.</para>
+
+ <para>It is possible to manually enter the port numbers to open. Click on
+<guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> and a new window is opened. In the field
+<guilabel>Other ports</guilabel>, enter the needed ports following these
+examples :</para>
+
+ <para>80/tcp : open the port 80 tcp protocol</para>
+
+ <para>24000:24010/udp : open all the ports from 24000 to 24010 udp protocol</para>
+
+ <para>The listed ports should be separated by a space.</para>
+
+ <para>If the box <guilabel>Log firewall messages in system logs</guilabel> is
+checked, the firewall messages will be saved in system logs</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakfirewall2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you don't host specific services (web or mail server, file sharing, ...)
+it is completely possible to have nothing checked at all, it is even
+recommended, it won't prevent you from connecting to the internet.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>The next screen deals with the Interactive Firewall options. These feature
+allow you to be warned of connection attempts if at least the first box
+<guilabel>Use Interactive Firewall </guilabel>is checked. Check the second
+box to be warned if the ports are scanned (in order to find a failure
+somewhere and enter your machine). Each box from the third one onwards
+corresponds to a port you opened in the two first screens; in the screenshot
+below, there are two such boxes: SSH server and 80:150/tcp. Check them to be
+warned each time a connection is attempted on those ports.</para>
+
+ <para>These warning are given by alert popups through the network applet.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakfirewall3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakfirewall4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In the last screen, choose which network interfaces are connected to the
+Internet and must be protected. Once the OK button is clicked, the necessary
+packages are downloaded.</para>
+
+ <tip>
+ <para>If you don't know what to choose, have a look in MCC tab Network &amp;
+Internet, icon Set up a new network interface.</para>
+ </tip>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfont.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfont.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0ce1d543
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakfont.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakfont">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakfont-ti1">フォントの管理・追加・削除と Windows® フォントのインポート</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakfont</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakfont-im1" fileref="drakfont.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakfont</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the <emphasis role="bold">System</emphasis> tab. It
+allows you to manage the fonts available on the computer. The main screen
+above shows:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the installed font names, styles and sizes.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>a preview of the selected font.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>some buttons explained here later.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Get Windows Fonts: </emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This button automatically adds the fonts found on the Windows partition. You
+must have Microsoft Windows installed.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Options:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>It allows you to specify the applications or devices (printers mostly) able
+to use the fonts.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Uninstall:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This button is to remove installed fonts and possibly save some place. Be
+careful when removing fonts because it may have serious consequences on the
+documents that use them.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Import:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Allows you to add fonts from a third party (CD, internet, ...). The
+supported formats are ttf, pfa, pfb, pcf, pfm and gsf. Click on the
+<emphasis role="bold">Import</emphasis> button and then on <emphasis
+role="bold">Add</emphasis>, a file manager pops up where you can select the
+fonts to install, click on <emphasis role="bold">Install</emphasis> when
+done. They are installed in the folder /usr/share/fonts.</para>
+
+ <para>If the newly installed (or removed) fonts doesn't appear in the Drakfont
+main screen, close and re open it to see the modifications.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakguard.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakguard.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..144afc88
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakguard.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakguard">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakguard-ti1">パレンタルコントロール</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakguard</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakguard.png" revision="1" xml:id="drakguard-im1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakguard</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found in the Mageia
+Control Center, under the Security tab, labelled <guilabel>Parental
+Control</guilabel>. If you don't see this label, you have to install the
+drakguard package (not installed by default).</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Presentation</title>
+
+ <para>Drakguard is an easy way to set up parental controls on your computer to
+restrict who can do what, and at which times of day. Drakguard has three
+useful capabilities:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It restricts web access to named users to set times of day. It does this by
+controlling the shorewall firewall built into Mageia.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It blocks execution of particular commands by named users so these users can
+only execute what you accept them to execute.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It restricts access to websites, both manually defined through
+blacklists/whitelists, but also dynamically based on the content of the
+website. To achieve this Drakguard uses the leading opensource parental
+control blocker DansGuardian.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Configuring Parental controls</title>
+
+ <para><warning>
+ <para>If your computer contains hard drive partitions that are formatted in Ext2,
+Ext3, or ReiserFS format you will see a pop up offering to configure ACL on
+your partitions. ACL stands for Access Control Lists, and is a Linux kernel
+feature that allows access to individual files to be restricted to named
+users. ACL is built into Ext4 and Btrfs file systems, but must be enabled by
+an option in Ext2, Ext3, or Reiserfs partitions. If you select 'Yes' to this
+prompt drakguard will configure all your partitions to support ACL, and will
+then suggest you reboot.</para>
+ </warning><guibutton>Enable parental control</guibutton>: If checked, the parental
+control is enabled and the access to <guilabel>Block programs</guilabel> tab
+is opened.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Block all network traffic</guibutton>: If checked, all the
+websites are blocked, except the ones in the whitelist tab. Otherwise, all
+the websites are allowed, except the ones in the blacklist tab.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>User access</guibutton>: Users on the left hand side will have
+their access restricted according to the rules you define. Users on the
+right hand side have unrestricted access so adult users of the computer are
+not inconvenienced. Select a user in the left hand side and click on
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> to add him/her as an allowed user. Select an
+user in the right hand side and click on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to
+remove him/her from the allowed users.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Time control:</guibutton> If checked, internet access is allowed
+with restrictions between the <guilabel>Start</guilabel> time and
+<guilabel>End</guilabel> time. It is totally blocked outside these time
+window.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Blacklist/Whitelist tab</title>
+
+ <para>Enter the website URL in the first field at the top and click on the
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> button.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Block Programs Tab</title>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Block Defined Applications</guibutton>: Enables the use of ACL to
+restrict access to specific applications. Insert the path to the
+applications you wish to block.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Unblock Users list</guibutton>: Users listed on the right hand
+side will not be subject to acl blocking.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakgw.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakgw.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6216ec5f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakgw.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,123 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakgw" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakgw-ti1">他のローカルマシンとインターネット接続を共有</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakgw</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakgw.png" format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="drakgw-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-principles">
+ <title>Principles</title>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../drakgw-net.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>This is useful when you have a
+computer (3) which has Internet (2) access and is connected also to a local
+network (1). You can use computer (3) as a gateway to give that access to
+other workstations (5) and (6) in the local network (1). For this, the
+gateway must have two interfaces; the first one such as an ethernet card
+must be connected to the local network, and the second one (4) connected to
+the Internet (2).</para>
+
+ <para>The first step is to verify that the network and the access to Internet are
+set up, as documented in <xref linkend="draknetcenter"/>.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-wizard">
+ <title>Gateway wizard</title>
+
+ <para>The wizard<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakgw</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> offers successive steps
+which are shown below:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If the wizard does not detect at least two interfaces, it warns about this
+and asks to stop the network and configure the hardware.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify the interface used for the Internet connection. The wizard
+automatically suggests one of the interfaces, but you should verify that
+what is proposed is correct.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify which interface is used for the Lan access. The wizard also proposes
+one, check that this is correct.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The wizard proposes parameters for the Lan network, such as IP address, mask
+and domain name. Check that these parameters are compatible with the actual
+configuration. It is recommended that you accept these values.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify if the computer has to be used as a DNS server. If yes, the wizard
+will check that <code>bind</code> is installed. Otherwise, you have to
+specify the address of a DNS server.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify if the computer is to be used as a DHCP server. If yes, the wizard
+will check that <code>dhcp-server</code> is installed and offer to configure
+it, with start and end addresses in the DHCP range.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>specify if the computer is to be used as a proxy server. If yes, the wizard
+will check that <code>squid</code> is installed and offer to configure it,
+with the address of the administrator (admin@mydomain.com), name of the
+proxy (myfirewall@mydomaincom), the port (3128) and the cache size (100 Mb).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The last step allows you to check if the gateway machine is connected to
+printers and to share them.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+
+ <para>You will be warned about the need to check the firewall if it is active.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-configure">
+ <title>Configure the client</title>
+
+ <para>If you have configured the gateway machine with DHCP, you only need to
+specify in the network configuration tool that you get an address
+automatically (using DHCP). The parameters will be obtained when connecting
+to the network. This method is valid whatever operating system the client is
+using.</para>
+
+ <para>If you must manually specify the network parameters, you must in particular
+specify the gateway by entering the IP-address of the machine acting as the
+gateway.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="drakgw-stop">
+ <title>Stop connection sharing</title>
+
+ <para>If you want to stop sharing the connection on the Mageia computer, launch
+the tool. It will offer to reconfigure the connection or to stop the
+sharing.</para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakhosts.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakhosts.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..45aa9935
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakhosts.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakhosts" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakhosts-ti1">ホストの定義</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakhosts</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" fileref="drakhosts.png" format="PNG" xml:id="drakhosts-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If some systems on your network grant you services, and have fixed
+IP-addresses, this tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakhosts</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows to
+specify a name to access them more easily. Then you can use that name
+instead of the IP-address.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Add</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>With this button, you add the name for a new system. You will get a window
+to specify the IP-address, the host name for the system, and optionally an
+alias which can be used in the same way that the name is.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Modify</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>You can access the parameters of an entry previously defined. You get the
+same window.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakinvictus.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakinvictus.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c19a7da2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakinvictus.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakinvictus" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakinvictus-ti1">ネットワークインターフェースとファイアウォールの高度な設定</title><subtitle>drakinvictus</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakinvictus-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakinvictus.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakinvictus</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetcenter.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetcenter.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..43f50f50
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetcenter.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,220 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="draknetcenter" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Written AM desmottes (lebarhon) 2012-08-31
+Write some text means i can't do it :(
+What must we say about networks out of wired (Ethernet) and wireless (WI fi) like GPRS, bluetooth ? I can't write anything.
+-->
+<!-- -->
+<title xml:id="draknetcenter-ti1">ネットワークセンター</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draknetcenter</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="draknetcenter.png" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="draknetcenter-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draknetcenter</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the Network
+&amp; Internet tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled "Network Center"</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>When this tool is launched, a window opens listing all the networks
+configured on the computer, whatever their type (wired, wireless, satellite,
+etc.). When clicking on one of them, three or four buttons appear, depending
+on the network type, to allow you to look after the network, change its
+settings or connect/disconnect. This tool isn't intended to create a
+network, for this see <guilabel>Set up a new network interface (LAN, ISDN,
+ADSL, ...)</guilabel> in the same MCC tab.</para>
+
+ <para>In the screenshot below, given as example, we can see two networks, the
+first one is wired and connected, recognizable by this icon <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterEthernet-on.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject> (this one is not connected<inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterEthernet-off.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject> ) and the second section shows wireless
+networks, not connected recognizable by this icon <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterWireless-off.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject> and this one <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../draknetcenterWireless-on.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject>if connected. For the other network types,
+the colour code is always the same, green if connected and red if not
+connected.</para>
+
+ <para>In the wireless part of the screen, you can also see all the detected
+networks, with the <guilabel>SSID</guilabel>, the <guilabel>Signal
+strengh</guilabel>, if they are encrypted (in red) or not (in green), and
+the <guilabel>Operating mode</guilabel>. Click on the chosen one and then
+either on <guibutton>Monitor</guibutton>, <guibutton>Configure</guibutton>
+or <guibutton>Connect</guibutton>. It is possible here to go from a network
+to another one. If a private network is selected, the Network Settings
+window (see below) will open and ask you for extra settings ( an encryption
+key in particular).</para>
+
+ <para>Click on <guibutton>Refresh</guibutton> to update the screen.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The Monitor button</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This button allows you to watch the network activity, downloads (toward the
+PC, in red) and uploads (toward the Internet, in green). The same screen is
+available by right clicking on the <guimenu>Internet icon in the system tray
+-> Monitor Network</guimenu>.</para>
+
+ <para>There is a tab for each network (here eth0 is the wired network, lo the
+local loopback and wlan0 the wireless network) and a tab connection which
+gives details about connection status.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>At the bottom of the window is a title <guilabel>Traffic
+accounting</guilabel>, we will look at that in the next section.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The Configure button</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">A - For a wired network</emphasis></para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>It is possible to change all the settings given during network
+creation. Most of the time, checking <guibutton>Automatic IP</guibutton>
+<guibutton>(BOOTP/DHCP)</guibutton> will do, but in case of problems, manual
+configuration may give better results.</para>
+
+ <para>For a residential network, the <guilabel>IP address</guilabel> always looks
+like 192.168.0.x, <guilabel>Netmask</guilabel> is 255.255.255.0, and the
+<guilabel>Gateway</guilabel> and <guilabel>DNS servers</guilabel> are
+available from your providers website.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Enable traffic accounting</guibutton> if checked this will count
+the traffic on a hourly, daily or monthly basis. The results are visible in
+the Network monitor detailed in the previous section. Once enabled, you may
+have to reconnect to the network.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Allow interface to be controlled by Network
+Manager:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>The button Advanced:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">B - For a wireless network</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Only the items not already seen above are explained.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Operating mode:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Select <guilabel>Managed</guilabel> if the connection is via an access
+point, there is an <emphasis role="bold">ESSID</emphasis> detected. Select
+<guilabel>Ad-hoc</guilabel> if it is a peer to peer network. Select
+<emphasis role="bold">Master</emphasis> if your network card is used as the
+access point, your network card needs to support this mode.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Encryption mode and Encryption key:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>If it is a private network, you need to know these settings.</para>
+
+ <para><guilabel>WEP</guilabel> uses a password and is weaker than WPA which uses a
+passphrase. <guilabel>WPA Pre-Shared Key</guilabel> is also called WPA
+personal or WPA home. <guilabel>WPA Enterprise</guilabel> is not often used
+in private networks.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Allow access point roaming</emphasis>:</para>
+
+ <para>Roaming is a technology which enables allows computer to change its access
+point while remaining connected to the network.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>The button Advanced:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The Advanced Settings button</title>
+
+ <para>This section hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draknetcenter7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetprofile.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetprofile.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6878ba6f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknetprofile.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="draknetprofile" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draknetprofile-ti1">ネットワークプロファイルを管理</title><subtitle>draknetprofile</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="draknetprofile-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="draknetprofile.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draknetprofile</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknfs.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknfs.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..02375494
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draknfs.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,165 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="draknfs" xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draknfs-ti1">NFS を使ってドライブ/ディレクトリを共有</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draknfs</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draknfs.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draknfs-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Prerequisites</title>
+
+ <para>When the wizard<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draknfs</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is launched for the
+first time, it may display the following message:</para>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <para>The package nfs-utils needs to be installed. Do you want to install it?</para>
+ </blockquote>
+
+ <para>After completing the installation, a window with an empty list is displayed.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Main window</title>
+
+ <para>A list of directories which are shared is displayed. At this step, the list
+is empty. The <guibutton>Add</guibutton> button gives access to a
+configuration tool.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>エントリを変更</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration tool is labeled "Modify entry". It may be also launched
+with the <guibutton>Modify</guibutton> button. The following parameters are
+available.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draknfs4.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draknfs-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>NFS Directory</title>
+
+ <para>Here you can specify which directory is to be shared. The
+<guibutton>Directory</guibutton> button gives access to a browser to choose
+it.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>ホストアクセス</title>
+
+ <para>Here you can specify the hosts that are authorized to access the shared
+directory.</para>
+
+ <para>NFS clients may be specified in a number of ways:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>single host</emphasis>: a host either by an abbreviated name
+recognized be the resolver, fully qualified domain name, or an IP address</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>netgroups</emphasis>: NIS netgroups may be given as @group.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>wildcards</emphasis>: machine names may contain the wildcard
+characters * and ?. For instance: *.cs.foo.edu matches all hosts in the
+domain cs.foo.edu.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>IP networks</emphasis>: you can also export directories to all
+hosts on an IP (sub-)network simultaneously. For example, either
+`/255.255.252.0' or `/22' appended to the network base address.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>ユーザ ID マッピング</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis>map root user as anonymous</emphasis>: maps requests from uid/gid
+0 to the anonymous uid/gid (root_squash). The root user from the client
+cannot read or write to the files on the server which are created by root on
+the server itself.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>allow real remote root access</emphasis>: turn off root
+squashing. This option is mainly useful for diskless clients
+(no_root_squash).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>map all users to anonymous user</emphasis>: maps all uids and gids
+to the anonymous user (all_squash). Useful for NFS-exported public FTP
+directories, news spool directories, etc. The opposite option is no user UID
+mapping (no_all_squash), which is the default setting.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>anonuid and anongid</emphasis>: explicitly set the uid and gid of
+the anonymous account.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>上級オプション</title>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Secured Connection</emphasis>: this option requires that requests
+originate on an internet port less than IPPORT_RESERVED (1024). This option
+is on by default.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Read-Only share</emphasis>: allow either only read or both read
+and write requests on this NFS volume. The default is to disallow any
+request which changes the filesystem. This can also be made explicit by
+using this option.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Synchronous access</emphasis>: prevents the NFS server from
+violating the NFS protocol and to reply to requests before any changes made
+by these requests have been committed to stable storage (e.g. disc drive).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Subtree checking</emphasis>: enable subtree checking which can
+help improve security in some cases, but can decrease reliability. See
+exports(5) man page for more details.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Menu entries</title>
+
+ <para>So far the list has at least one entry.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draknfs5.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draknfs-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>File|Write conf</title>
+
+ <para>Save the current configuration.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>NFS Server|Restart</title>
+
+ <para>The server is stopped and restarted with the current configuration files.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>NFS Server|Reload</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration displayed is reloaded from the current configuration
+files.</para>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakproxy.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakproxy.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..2d3f2b40
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakproxy.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakproxy"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakproxy-ti1">プロクシ</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakproxy</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakproxy.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakproxy-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If you have to use a proxy server to access to the internet, you can use
+this tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakproxy</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> to configure it. Your net
+administrator will give you the information you need. You can also specify
+some services which can be accessed without the proxy by exception.</para>
+
+ <para>From Wikipedia, on 2012-09-24, article Proxy server: In computer networks, a
+proxy server is a server (a computer system or an application) that acts as
+an intermediary for requests from clients seeking resources from other
+servers. A client connects to the proxy server, requesting some service,
+such as a file, connection, web page, or other resource available from a
+different server. The proxy server evaluates the request as a way to
+simplify and control their complexity.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakrpm-edit-media.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakrpm-edit-media.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c24588a2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakrpm-edit-media.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,211 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-ti1">Configure Media</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakrpm-edit-media</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <!-- 2013-01-06 marja - added Qilaq's and spturtle's corrections -->
+<!--2013-10-22 marja - improved wording, thanks to Aragorn :-)
+ - adjusted "Add" part to changed behaviour of this tool
+ (no longer a choice to only add "update sources" is
+ given) -->
+<imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-im1" fileref="drakrpm-edit-media.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><important>
+ <para>First thing to do after an install is to add software sources (also known as
+repositories, media, mirrors). That means you must select the media sources
+to be used to install and update packages and applications. (see Add button
+below).</para>
+ </important> <note>
+ <para>If you install (or upgrade) Mageia using an optical media (DVD or CD) or a
+USB device, there will be a software source configured to the optical media
+used. To avoid being asked to insert the media when you install new
+packages, you should disable (or delete) this media.  (It will have the
+media type CD-Rom).</para>
+ </note> <note>
+ <para>Your system is running under an architecture which may be 32-bit (called
+i586), or 64-bit (called x86_64). Some packages are independent of whether
+your system is 32-bit or 64-bit; these are called noarch packages. They
+don't have their own noarch directories on the mirrors, but are all in both
+the i586 and the x86_64 media.</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para>This tool is present in the Mageia Control Center under the tab <emphasis
+role="bold">Software management.</emphasis><footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakrpm-edit-media</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote></para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-columns">The columns</title>
+
+ <bridgehead>Column Enable:</bridgehead>
+
+ <para>The checked media will be used to install new packages. Be cautious with
+some media such as Testing and Debug, they could make your system unusable.</para>
+
+ <bridgehead>Column Update:</bridgehead>
+
+ <para>The checked media will be used to update packages, it must be enabled. Only
+media with "Update" in its name should be selected. For security reasons,
+this column isn't modifiable in this tool, you must open a console as root
+and type <emphasis role="bold">drakrpm-edit-media --expert.</emphasis></para>
+
+ <bridgehead>Column medium:</bridgehead>
+
+ <para>Display the medium name. Mageia official repositories for final release
+versions contain at least:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Core</emphasis> which contains most programs available
+supported by Mageia.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Nonfree</emphasis> which contains some programs which
+are not free</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Tainted</emphasis> free software for which there might
+be patent claims in some countries.</para>
+
+ <para>Each medium has 4 sub-sections:</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Release</emphasis> the packages as of the day the this
+version of Mageia was released.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Updates</emphasis> the packages updated since release
+due to security or bug concerns. Everyone should have this medium enabled,
+even with a very slow internet connection.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Backports</emphasis> some packages of new versions
+backported from Cauldron (the next version under development).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Testing</emphasis> which is used for temporary tests
+of new updates, to allow the bug reporters and the QA team to validate the
+corrections.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-right-button">The buttons on the right</title>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Remove:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>To remove a medium, click on it and then on this button. It is wise to
+remove the medium used for the installation (CD or DVD for example) since
+all the packages it contains are in the official Core release medium.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Edit:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>Allows you to modify the selected medium settings, (URL, downloader and
+proxy).</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Add:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>Add the official repositories available on the Internet. These repositories
+contain only safe and well tested software. Clicking on the "Add" button
+adds the mirrorlist to your configuration, it is designed to make sure that
+you install and update from a mirror close to you. If you prefer to choose a
+specific mirror, then add it by choosing "Add a specific media mirror" from
+the drop-down "File" menu.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Up and down arrows:</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>Change the list order. When Drakrpm looks for a package, it reads the list
+in the displayed order and will install the first package found for the same
+release number - in the event of a version mismatch, the latest release will
+be installed. So if possible, put the fastest repositories at the top.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="drakrpm-edit-media-menu">The menu</title>
+
+ <para><guimenu>File -> Update:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>A window pops up with the media list. Select the ones you want to update and
+click on the <guibutton>Update</guibutton> button.</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>File -> Add a specific media mirror:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>Suppose you aren't happy with the actual mirror, because for example it's
+too slow or often unavailable, you can choose another mirror. Select all the
+actual media and click on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to take them
+out. Click on <guimenu>File -> Add a specific media mirror</guimenu>, choose
+between update only or the full set (if you do not know, choose the
+<guibutton>Full set of sources</guibutton>) and accept the contact by
+clicking on <guibutton>Yes</guibutton>. This window opens:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakrpmEditMedia2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You can see, on the left, a list of countries, choose yours or one very
+close by clicking on the > symbol, this will display all the available
+mirrors in that country. Select one and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>File -> Add a custom medium:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>It is possible to install a new media (from a third party for example) that
+isn't supported by Mageia. A new window appears:</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrakeEditMedia1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>Select the medium type, find a smart
+name that well define the medium and give the URL (or the path, according to
+the medium type)</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>Options -> Global options:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>This item allows you to choose when to "Verify RPMs to be installed" (always
+or never), the download program (curl, wget or aria2) and to define the
+download policy for information about the packages (on demand -by default-,
+update only, always or never).</para>
+
+ <para><guimenu>Options -> Manage keys:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>To guarantee a high level of security, digital keys are used to authenticate
+the media. It is possible for each medium to allow or disallow a key. In the
+window that appear, select a medium and then click on
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> to allow a new key or to select a key and click
+on <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> to disallow that key.</para>
+
+ <para><warning>
+ <para>Do this with care, as with all security-related questions</para>
+ </warning><guimenu>Options -> Proxy:</guimenu></para>
+
+ <para>If you need to use a proxy server for internet access, you can configure it
+here. You only need to give the <guibutton>Proxy hostname</guibutton> and if
+necessary a <guilabel>Username</guilabel> and <guilabel>Password</guilabel>.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>For more information about configuring the media, see <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Software_management">the Mageia Wiki
+page</link>.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksambashare.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksambashare.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..baa2b5bd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksambashare.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,251 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="draksambashare"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksambashare-ti1">Share directories and drives with Samba</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draksambashare</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>Samba is a protocol used in different Operating Systems to share some
+resources like directories or printers. This tool allows you to configure
+the machine as a Samba server using the protocol SMB/CIFS. This protocol is
+also used by Windows(R) and workstations with this OS can access the
+resources of the Samba server.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Preparation</title>
+
+ <para>To be accessed from other workstations, the server has to have a fixed IP
+address. This can be specified directly on the server, for example with
+<xref linkend="draknetcenter-ti1"/>, or at the DHCP server which identifies
+the station with its MAC-address and give it always the same address. The
+firewall has also to allow the incoming requests to the Samba server.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Wizard - Standalone server</title>
+
+ <para>At the first run, the tools <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing<emphasis
+role="bold"> draksambashare</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> checks if
+needed packages are installed and proposes to install them if they are not
+yet present. Then the wizard to configure the Samba server is launched.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare0.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare0-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In the next window the Standalone server configuration option is already
+selected.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare1.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare1-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Then specify the name of the workgroup. This name should be the same for the
+access to the shared resources.</para>
+
+ <para>The netbios name is the name which will be used to designate the server on
+the network.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare2-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose the security mode:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>user</guilabel>: the client must be authorized to access the
+resource</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>share</guilabel>: the client authenticates itself separately for
+each share</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>You can specify which hosts are allowed to access the resources, with IP
+address or host name.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare3.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draksambashare3-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Specify the server banner. The banner is the way this server will be
+described in the Windows workstations.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare4.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The place where Samba can log information can be specified at the next step.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare5.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The wizard displays a list of the chosen parameters before you accept the
+configuration. When accepted, the configuration will be written in
+<code>/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare6.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Wizard - Primary domain controller</title>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare13.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>If the "Primary domain controller"
+option is selected, the wizard asks for indication if Wins is to support or
+not and to provide admin users names. The following steps are then the same
+as for standalone server, except you can choose also the security mode:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guilabel>domain</guilabel>: provides a mechanism for storing all user and
+group accounts in a central, shared, account repository. The centralized
+account repository is shared between (security) controllers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Declare a directory to share</title>
+
+ <para>With the <guibutton>Add</guibutton> button, we get:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare15.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="draksambashare-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>A new entry is thus added. It can be modified with the
+<guibutton>Modify</guibutton> button. Options can be edited, such as whether
+the directory is visible to the public, writable or browseable. The share
+name can not be modified.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="draksambashare16.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="draksambashare-im8"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Menu entries</title>
+
+ <para>When the list has at least one entry, menu entries can be used.</para>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>File|Write conf</title>
+
+ <para>Save the current configuration in <code>/etc/samba/smb.conf</code>.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>Samba server|Configure</title>
+
+ <para>The wizard can be run again with this command.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>Samba server|Restart</title>
+
+ <para>The server is stopped and restarted with the current configuration files.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+
+ <formalpara>
+ <title>Samba Server|Reload</title>
+
+ <para>The configuration displayed is reloaded from the current configuration
+files.</para>
+ </formalpara>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Printers share</title>
+
+ <para>Samba also allows you to share printers.</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare17.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Samba users</title>
+
+ <para>In this tab, you can add users who are allowed to access the shared
+resources when authentication is required. You can add users from <xref
+linkend="userdrake-ti1"/><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksambashare18.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksec.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksec.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..84de8c0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksec.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="draksec">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksec-ti1">Mageia ツールの認証を設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draksec</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="draksec-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="draksec0.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draksec</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote>is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Security</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>It allows to give the regular users the needed rights to accomplish tasks
+usually done by the administrator.</para>
+
+ <para>Click on the little arrow before the item you want to drop down:
+ </para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="draksec.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Most of the tools available in the Mageia Control Center are displayed in
+the left side of the window (see the screenshot above) and for each tool, a
+drop down list on the right side gives the choice between:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Default: The launch mode depends on the chosen security level. See in the
+same MCC tab, the tool "Configure system security, permissions and audit".</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>User password: The user password is asked before the tool launching.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Administrator password: The root password is asked before the tool launching</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>No password: The tool is launched without asking any password.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksnapshot-config.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksnapshot-config.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..7f3b0d94
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksnapshot-config.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xml:id="draksnapshot-config" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksnapshot-config-ti1">スナップショット</title>
+ <subtitle>draksnapshot-config</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="draksnapshot-config-im1" revision="1" align="center"
+ format="PNG" fileref="draksnapshot-config.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draksnapshot-config </emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> is available in MCC's
+<guilabel>System</guilabel> tab, in the <guilabel>Administration
+tools</guilabel> section.</para>
+ <para>When you start this tool in MCC for the first time, you will see a message
+about installing draksnapshot. Click on <guibutton>Install</guibutton> to
+proceed. Draksnapshot and some other packages it needs will be installed.</para>
+
+ <para>Click again on <guilabel>Snapshots</guilabel>, you will see the
+<guilabel>Settings</guilabel> screen. Tick <guilabel>Enable
+Backups</guilabel> and, if you want to backup the whole system,
+<guilabel>Backup the whole system</guilabel>.</para>
+ <para>If you only want to backup part of your directories, then choose
+<guilabel>Advanced</guilabel>. You will see a little pop-up screen. Use the
+<guibutton>Add</guibutton> and <guibutton>Remove</guibutton> buttons next to
+the <guilabel>Backup list</guilabel> to include or exclude directories and
+files from the backup. Use the same buttons next to the
+<guilabel>Exclude</guilabel> list to remove subdirectories and/or files from
+the chosen directories, that should <emphasis role="bold">not</emphasis> be
+included in the backup. Click on <guibutton>Close</guibutton> when you are
+done.</para>
+ <para>Now give the path to <guilabel>Where to backup</guilabel>, or choose the
+<guibutton>Browse</guibutton> button to select the correct path. Any mounted
+USB-key or external HD can be found in <emphasis
+role="bold">/run/media/your_user_name/</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+ <para>Click on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton> to make the snapshot.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksound.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksound.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..a30236c9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/draksound.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,61 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="draksound" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="draksound-ti1">サウンドの設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>draksound</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="draksound-im1" fileref="draksound.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">draksound</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Hardware</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>Draksound deals with the sound configuration, including the driver choice,
+PulseAudio options and trouble shooting. It will help you if you experience
+sound problems or if you change the sound card.</para>
+
+ <para>The drop down list called <guilabel>Driver</guilabel> allows you to select a
+driver from all the ones available on the computer that match the sound
+card.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Most of the time, it is possible to choose a driver using the OSS or ALSA
+API. OSS is the oldest and very basic, we recommend to choose ALSA when
+possible for its enhanced features.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para><guilabel>PulseAudio</guilabel> is a sound server. It receives all the sound
+inputs, mixes them according to the user preferences and sends the resulting
+sound to the output. See <guimenu>Menu ->Sound and video -> PulseAudio
+volume control</guimenu> to set these preferences.</para>
+
+ <para>PulseAudio is the default sound server and it is recommended to leave it
+enabled.</para>
+
+ <para><guilabel>Glitch-Free</guilabel> improves PulseAudio with some programs. It
+is also recommended to leave it enabled.</para>
+
+ <para>The button <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> display a new window with two or
+three buttons:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="Draksound1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first button gives total freedom of choice. You have to know what you
+are doing. This button is not available when the system has found a driver
+for your device.</para>
+
+ <para>The second one is obvious and the last one gives assistance with fixing any
+problems you may have. You will find it helpful to try this before asking
+the community for help.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakups.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakups.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8abfcaa6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakups.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakups" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakups-ti1">電源管理のための UPS を設定</title><subtitle>drakups</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakups-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakups.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakups</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakvpn.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakvpn.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..70ee2fab
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakvpn.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,81 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakvpn">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakvpn-ti1">Configure VPN Connection to secure network access</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakvpn</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" xml:id="drakvpn-im1" align="center" fileref="drakvpn1.png" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakvpn</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows to configure secure
+access to a remote network establishing a tunnel between the local
+workstation and the remote network. We discuss here only of the
+configuration on the workstation side. We assume that the remote network is
+already in operation, and that you have the connection information from the
+network administrator, like a .pcf configuration file .</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>設定</title>
+
+ <para>First, select either Cisco VPN Concentrator or OpenVPN, depending on which
+protocol is used for your virtual private network.</para>
+
+ <para>Then give your connection a name.</para>
+
+ <para>At the next screen, provide the details for your VPN connection.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>For Cisco VPN</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakvpn3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>For openvpn. The openvpn package and its dependencies will be installed the
+first time the tool is used.</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakvpn7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>Select the files that you received
+from the network administrator.</para>
+
+ <para>Advanced parameters:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakvpn8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The next screen asks for IP-address of the gateway.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>When the parameters are set, you have the option of starting the VPN
+connection.</para>
+
+ <para>This VPN connection can be set to start automatically with a network
+connection. To do this, reconfigure the network connection to always connect
+to this VPN.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_apache2.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_apache2.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b0527f02
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_apache2.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_apache2" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-ti1">Configure webserver</title><subtitle>drakwizard apache2</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_apache2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard apache2</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can help you to set up a web
+server.
+ </para>
+ <section>
+ <title>What is a web server?</title>
+ <para>
+ Web server is the software that helps to deliver web content that can be
+accessed through the Internet. (From Wikipedia)
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up a web server with drakwizard apache2</title>
+ <para>
+ Welcome to the web server wizard.
+ </para>
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>序文</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting Server Exposer: Local Net and/or World</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Exposing the web server to the Internet has it's risks. Be ready for bad
+things.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server User Module</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im4" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Allows users to create their own sites.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>User web directory name</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im5" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ The user needs to create and populate this directory, then the server will
+display it.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server Document Root</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im6" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Allows you to configure the path to the web servers default documents.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>まとめ</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im7" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>完了</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_apache2-im8" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-web-step7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_bind.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_bind.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..87bfd912
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_bind.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,20 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_bind" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_bind-ti1">DNS を設定</title><subtitle>drakwizard bind</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_bind-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_bind.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard bind</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_dhcp.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_dhcp.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..81a98ae2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_dhcp.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,194 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-ti1">DHCP を設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakwizard dhcp</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im1" fileref="drakwizard_dhcp.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><note>
+ <para>This tool is broken in Mageia 4 because of new naming scheme for the Net
+interfaces</para>
+ </note></para>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard dhcp</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> can help you to set up a
+<acronym>DHCP</acronym> server. It is a component of drakwizard which should
+be installed before you can access to it.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is DHCP?</title>
+
+ <para>The Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (<acronym>DHCP</acronym>) is a
+standardized networking protocol used on IP networks that dynamically
+configures IP addresses and other information that is needed for Internet
+communication. (From Wikipedia)</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up a DHCP server with drakwizard dhcp</title>
+
+ <para>Welcome to the DHCP server wizard.</para>
+
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting Adaptor</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose the network interface, which is connected to the subnet, and for
+which DHCP will assign IP addresses, and then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Select IP range</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step3.png" format="PNG" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Select the beginning and ending IP addresses of the range of IPs you want
+the server to offer, along with the IP of the gateway machine connecting to
+some place outside the local network, hopefully close to the Internet, then
+click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>まとめ</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step4.png" revision="1" align="center" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im5" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Hold on...</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step5.png" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This can be fixed. Click <guibutton>Previous</guibutton> a few times and
+change things around.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Hours later...</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" fileref="drakwizard-dhcp-step6.png" align="center" format="PNG" xml:id="drakwizard_dhcp-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is done</title>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Installing the package dhcp-server if needed;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Saving <code>/etc/dhcpd.conf</code> in <code>/etc/dhcpd.conf.orig;</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Creating a new <code>dhcpd.conf</code> starting from
+<code>/usr/share/wizards/dhcp_wizard/scripts/dhcpd.conf.default</code> and
+adding the new parameters:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>hname</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>dns</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>net</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>ip</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>mask</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>rng1</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>rng2</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>dname</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>gateway</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>tftpserverip</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>dhcpd_interface</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Also modifying Webmin configuration file
+<code>/etc/webmin/dhcpd/config</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Restarting <code>dhcpd.</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_ntp.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_ntp.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f51fbbe4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_ntp.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,117 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakwizard_ntp"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_ntp-ti1">時刻を設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakwizard ntp</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <!-- 2013-10-25 Lebarhon - 3 screenshots ready to be added when it is possible -->
+<imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard_ntp.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_ntp-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard ntp</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> purpose is to set the time of
+your server synchronised with an external server. It isn't installed by
+default and you have to also install the drakwizard and drakwizard-base
+packages.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Setup a NTP server with drakwizard ntp</title>
+
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <para>After a welcome screen (see above), the second one ask you to choose three
+time servers in the drop down lists and suggests to use pool.ntp.org twice
+because this server always points to available time servers.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-ntp1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-ntp2.png">
+ <info>
+<author> <personname/> </author> <pubdate/></info>
+ </imagedata>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <para>The following screens allows to choose the region and the city and then, you
+arrive on a summary. If something is wrong, you can obviously change it
+using the <guibutton>Previous</guibutton>button. If everything is right,
+click on the <guibutton>Next</guibutton> button to proceed to the test. It
+may take a while and you finally get this screen below:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="drakwizard-ntp3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <para>Click on the <guibutton>Finish</guibutton> button to close the tool</para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is done</title>
+
+ <para>This tool executes the following steps:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Installing the package <code>ntp</code> if needed</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Saving the files <code>/etc/sysconfig/clock</code> to
+<code>/etc/sysconfig/clock.orig</code> and
+<code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers</code> to
+<code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers.orig</code>;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Writing a new file <code>/etc/ntp/step-tickers</code> with the list of
+servers;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Modifying the file <code>/etc/ntp.conf</code> by inserting the first server
+name;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Stopping and starting <code>crond</code>, <code>atd</code> and
+<code>ntpd</code> services;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Setting the hardware clock to the current system time with UTC reference.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_proftpd.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_proftpd.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d42b8fb4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_proftpd.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,102 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-ti1">FTP を設定</title><subtitle>drakwizard proftpd</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_proftpd.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard proftpd</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can help you to set up an
+<acronym>FTP</acronym> server.
+ </para>
+ <section>
+ <title>What is <acronym>FTP</acronym>?</title>
+ <para>
+ File Transfer Protocol (<acronym>FTP</acronym>) is a standard network
+protocol used to transfer files from one host to another host over a
+<acronym>TCP</acronym>-based network, such as the Internet. (From Wikipedia)
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up an FTP server with drakwizard proftpd</title>
+ <para>
+ Welcome to the FTP wizard. Buckle up.
+ </para>
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>序文</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting Server Exposer: Local Net and/or World</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Exposing the FTP server to the Internet has it's risks. Be ready for bad
+things.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server Information</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im4" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Enter name the sever will use to introduce itself, someone to email
+complaints too and whether to allow root login access.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Server Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im5" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Set listening port, jailed user, allow resumes and/or <acronym>FXP</acronym>
+(File eXchange Protocol)
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>まとめ</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im6" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>完了</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_proftpd-im7" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-ftp-step6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_squid.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_squid.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1c09d034
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_squid.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,238 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="drakwizard_squid"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_squid-ti1">プロキシを設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>drakwizard squid</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard_squid.png" format="PNG"
+ revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard squid</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> can help you to set up a
+proxy server. It is a component of drakwizard which should be installed
+before you can access to it.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is a proxy server?</title>
+
+ <para>A proxy server is a server (a computer system or an application) that acts
+as an intermediary for requests from clients seeking resources from other
+servers. A client connects to the proxy server, requesting some service,
+such as a file, connection, web page, or other resource available from a
+different server and the proxy server evaluates the request as a way to
+simplify and control its complexity. (From Wikipedia)</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up a proxy server with drakwizard squid</title>
+
+ <para>Welcome to the proxy server wizard.</para>
+
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step1.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im2"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first page is just an introduction, click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Selecting the proxy port</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im3"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Select the proxy port browsers will connect through, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Set Memory and Disk Usage</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step3.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Set memory and disk cache limits, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Select Network Access Control</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step4.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Set visibility to local network or world, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Grant Network Access</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step5.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Grant access to local networks, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Use Upper Level Proxy Server?</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step6.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Cascade through another proxy server? If no, skip next step.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Upper Level Proxy URL and Port</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step7.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im8"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Provide upper level proxy hostname and port, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>まとめ</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step8.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im9"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>Start during boot?</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step9.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im10"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose if the proxy server should be started during the boot time, then
+click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+
+ <step>
+ <title>完了</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="drakwizard-proxy-step10.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="drakwizard_squid-im11"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.</para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>What is done</title>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Installing the package squid if needed;</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Saving <code>/etc/squid/squid.conf</code> in
+<code>/etc/squid/squid.conf.orig;</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Creating a new <code>squid.conf</code> starting from
+<code>squid.conf.default</code> and adding the new parameters:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>cache_dir</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>localnet</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>cache_mem</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>http_port</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>level</code> 1, 2 or 3 and <code>http_access</code> according to level</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>cache_peer</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><code>visible_hostname</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Restarting <code>squid.</code></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist></para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_sshd.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_sshd.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1f1cb7de
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakwizard_sshd.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakwizard_sshd" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-ti1">OpenSSHデーモンの設定</title><subtitle>drakwizard sshd</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard_sshd.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakwizard sshd</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> can help you to set up an
+<acronym>SSH</acronym> daemon.
+ </para>
+ <section>
+ <title>What is <acronym>SSH</acronym>?</title>
+ <para>
+ Secure Shell (SSH) is a cryptographic network protocol for secure data
+communication, remote command-line login, remote command execution, and
+other secure network services between two networked computers that connects,
+via a secure channel over an insecure network, a server and a client
+(running SSH server and <acronym>SSH</acronym> client programs,
+respectively). (From Wikipedia)
+ </para>
+ </section>
+ <section>
+ <title>Setting up an <acronym>SSH</acronym> daemon with drakwizard sshd</title>
+ <para>
+ Welcome to the Open SSH wizard.
+ </para>
+ <procedure>
+ <step>
+ <title>Select Type of Configure Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im2" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Choose <guilabel>Expert</guilabel> for all options or
+<guilabel>Newbie</guilabel> to skip steps 3-7, click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>全般オプション</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im3" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Sets visibility and root access options. Port 22 is the standard
+<acronym>SSH</acronym> port.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Authentication Methods</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im4" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Allow a variety of authentication methods users can use while connecting,
+then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Logging</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im5" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Choose logging facility and level of output, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Login Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im6" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Configure per-login settings, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>User Login Options</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im7" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Configure the user access settings, then click <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>Compression and Forwarding</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im8" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Configure X11 forwarding and compression during transfer, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>まとめ</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im9" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ Take a second to check these options, then click
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ <step>
+ <title>完了</title>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="drakwizard_sshd-im10" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakwizard-sshd-step9.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>
+ You're done! Click <guibutton>Finish</guibutton>.
+ </para>
+ </step>
+ </procedure>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakxservices.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakxservices.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..7198ce70
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/drakxservices.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="drakxservices" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="drakxservices-ti1">システムサービスを有効化/無効化</title><subtitle>drakxservices</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata width="80%" xml:id="drakxservices-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="drakxservices.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Doc
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">drakxservices</emphasis> as root.</para>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/harddrake2.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/harddrake2.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4164ff8b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/harddrake2.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,87 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="harddrake2"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="harddrake2-ti1">Hardware configuration</title>
+
+ <subtitle>harddrake2</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="harddrake2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="harddrake2-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">harddrake2</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> gives a general view of the
+hardware of your computer. When the tool is launched, it executes a job to
+look for every element of the hardware. For that, it uses the command
+<code>ldetect </code>which refers to a list of hardware in
+<code>ldetect-lst</code> package.</para>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The window</title>
+
+ <para>The window is divided in two columns.</para>
+
+ <para>The left column contains a list of the detected hardware. The devices are
+grouped by categories. Click on the &gt; to expand the content of a
+category. Each device can be selected in this column.</para>
+
+ <para>The right column displays information about the selected device. The
+<guimenu>Help -&gt; Fields description</guimenu> gives some information
+about the content of the fields.</para>
+
+ <para>According to which type of device is selected, either one or two buttons are
+available at the bottom of the right column:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guibutton>Set current driver options</guibutton>: this can be used to
+parameterize the module which is used in relation to the device. This must
+used by experts only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><guibutton>Run config tool</guibutton>: access to the tool which can
+configure the device. The tool can often be accessed directly from the MCC.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para/>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The menu</title>
+
+ <para><bridgehead>オプション</bridgehead></para>
+
+ <para>The <guimenu>options</guimenu> menu gives the opportunity to check boxes to
+enable automatic detection:</para>
+
+ <para><itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>modem</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Jaz devices</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Zip parallel devices</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>By default these detections are not enabled, because they are slow. Check
+the appropriate box(es) if you have this hardware connected. Detection will
+be operational the next time this tool is started.</para>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/keyboarddrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/keyboarddrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..56163612
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/keyboarddrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="keyboarddrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="keyboarddrake-ti1">Set up the Keyboard Layout</title>
+
+
+
+ <!-- 2012-09-02 marja changed the title to "Set up the Keyboard Layout", so it is the same as the title in MCC -->
+<subtitle>keyboarddrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" fileref="keyboarddrake.png" xml:id="keyboarddrake-im1" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>序文</title>
+
+ <para>The keyboarddrake tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">keyboarddrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> helps you
+configure the basic layout for the keyboard that you wish to use on
+Mageia. It affects the keyboard layout for all users on the system. It can
+be found in the Hardware section of the Mageia Control Center (MCC) labelled
+"Configure mouse and keyboard".</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Keyboard Layout</title>
+
+ <para>Here you can select which keyboard layout you wish to use. The names (listed
+in alphabetical order) describe the language, country, and/or ethnicity each
+layout should be used for.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Keyboard Type</title>
+
+ <para>This menu lets you select the type of keyboard you are using. If you are
+unsure of which to choose, it is best to leave it as the default type.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/localedrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/localedrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c6f56210
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/localedrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="localedrake"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="localedrake-ti1">システムの言語を設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>localedrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="localedrake.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="localedrake-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can also start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">localedrake</emphasis> as root.
+ </para></footnote> can be found in the System
+section of the Mageia Control Center (MCC) labelled "Manage localization for
+your system". It opens with a window in which you can choose your
+language. The choice is adapted to languages selected during installation.</para>
+
+ <para>The <guibutton>Advanced</guibutton> button give access to activate
+compatibility with old encoding (non UTF8).</para>
+
+ <para>The second window shows a list of countries according to the selected
+language. The button <guibutton>Other Countries</guibutton> gives access to
+countries not listed.</para>
+
+ <para>You have to restart your session after any modifications.</para>
+
+<section xml:id="input_method">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="input_method-ti1">Input method</title>
+ </info>
+ <para>In the <guilabel>Other Countries</guilabel> screen you can also select an
+input method (from the drop-down menu at the bottom of the list). Input
+methods allow users to input multilingual characters (Chinese, Japanese,
+Korean, etc).</para>
+ <para> For Asian and African locales, IBus will be set as default input method so
+users should not need to configure it manually.</para>
+ <para>Other input methods (SCIM, GCIN, HIME, etc.) also provide similar functions
+and can, if not available from the drop-down menu, be installed in another
+part of the Mageia Control Center. See <xref linkend="rpmdrake"></xref>.</para>
+</section>
+
+</section>
+
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/logdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/logdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..cb44132e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/logdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="logdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="logdrake-ti1">システムログを見る</title>
+
+ <subtitle>logdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="logdrake-im1" format="PNG" fileref="logdrake.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">logdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found in the Mageia
+Control Center System tab, labelled "<guilabel>View and search system
+logs</guilabel>".</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>To do a search in the logs</title>
+
+ <para>First, enter the key string you want to look for in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Matching</emphasis> field and/or the key string you want to
+<emphasis>do not</emphasis> wish to see amongst the answers in the field
+<emphasis role="bold">but not matching</emphasis>. Then select the file(s)
+to search in the <guilabel>Choose file</guilabel> field. Optionally, it is
+possible to limit the search to only one day. Select it in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Calendar</emphasis>, using the little arrows on each side of the
+month and year, and check "<guibutton>Show only for the selected
+day</guibutton>". At last, click on the <guibutton>search</guibutton> button
+to see the results in the window called <guilabel>Content of the
+file</guilabel>. It is possible to save the results in the .txt format by
+clicking on the <emphasis role="bold">Save</emphasis> button.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>The <guibutton>Mageia Tools Logs</guibutton> houses the logs from the Mageia
+configuration tools such as the Mageia Control Center tools. These logs are
+updated each time a configuration is modified.</para>
+ </note>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>To configure a mail alert</title>
+
+ <para><guibutton>Mail alert</guibutton> automatically checks the system load and
+the services every hour and if necessary sends an e-mail to the configured
+address.</para>
+
+ <para>To configure this tool, click on the <emphasis role="bold">Mail
+Alert</emphasis> button and then, in the next screen, on the<guibutton>
+Configure the mail alert system</guibutton> drop down button. Here, all the
+running services are displayed and you can choose which ones you want to
+look watch. (See screenshot above).</para>
+
+ <para>The following services can be watched :</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Webmin サービス</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Postfix メールサーバ</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>FTP サーバ</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Apache WWW サーバ</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>SSH サーバ</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>samba サーバ</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Xinetd サービス</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>BIND Domain Name Resolve</para>
+
+ <para><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="logdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>In the next screen, select the <guilabel>Load</guilabel> value you consider
+unacceptable. The load represents the demand to a process, a high load slows
+the system down and a very high load may indicate that a process has gone
+out of control. The default value is 3. We recommend setting the load value
+to 3 times the number of processors.</para>
+
+ <para>In the last screen, enter the <guilabel>Email address</guilabel> of the
+person to be warned and the <guilabel>Email server</guilabel> to use (local
+or on the Internet).</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/lsnetdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/lsnetdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..923d5a3b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/lsnetdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section
+xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+xml:id="lsnetdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="lsnetdrake-ti1">Display Available NFS And SMB Shares</title>
+ <subtitle>lsnetdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">lsnetdrake</emphasis>.
+ </para>
+ </footnote> can only be started and used
+on the command line.</para>
+
+ <para>This page hasn't been written yet for lack of resources. If you think you
+can write this help, please contact <link
+ns2:href="https://wiki.mageia.org/en/Documentation_team"> the Documentation
+team.</link> Thanking you in advance.</para>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/lspcidrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/lspcidrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3b1a4fa9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/lspcidrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="lspcidrake">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="lspcidrake-ti1">Display Your PCI, USB and PCMCIA Information</title>
+
+ <subtitle>lspcidrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">lspcidrake</emphasis>.</para>
+ </footnote> can only be started and used
+on the command line. It will give some more information if used under root.</para>
+
+ <para>lspcidrake gives the list of all the connected devices to the computer (USB,
+PCI and PCMCIA) and the used drivers. It needs the ldetect and ldetect-lst
+packages to work.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="lspcidrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>With the -v option, lspcidrake adds the vendor and device identifications.</para>
+
+ <para>lspcidrake often generates very long lists, so, to find an information, it
+is often used in a pipeline with the grep command, like in these examples:</para>
+
+ <para>Information about the graphic card;</para>
+
+ <para><command>lspcidrake | grep VGA</command></para>
+
+ <para>Information about the network</para>
+
+ <para><command>lspcidrake | grep -i network</command></para>
+
+ <para>-i to ignore case distinctions.</para>
+
+ <para>In this screenshot below, you can see the action of the -v option for
+lspcidrake and the -i option for grep.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="lspcidrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>There is another tool that gives information about the hardware, it is
+called <emphasis role="bold">dmidecode</emphasis> (under root)</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-boot.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-boot.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..d977e343
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-boot.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="mcc-boot">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-boot-ti1">起動</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-boot.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1" xml:id="mcc-boot-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools to configure your boot
+steps. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+
+ <orderedlist><title>起動方法の設定</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakautologin"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakboot"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakedm"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakautologin.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakboot.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakedm.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-hardware.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-hardware.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8b7bf18a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-hardware.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="mcc-hardware">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-hardware-ti1">ハードウェア</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-hardware.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-hardware-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools to configure your
+hardware. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>ハードウェアの管理</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="harddrake2"/><emphasis> = Browse and configure
+hardware</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draksound"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>グラフィックスの設定</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drak3d"/><emphasis> = Configure 3D Desktop effects</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="XFdrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>マウスとキーボードの設定</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="keyboarddrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="mousedrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>印刷とスキャンの設定</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="system-config-printer"/><emphasis> = Set up the printer(s),
+the print job queues, ...</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="scannerdrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>その他</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakups"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="harddrake2.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draksound.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drak3d.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="XFdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="keyboarddrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="mousedrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="system-config-printer.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="scannerdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakups.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-intro.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-intro.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b8fc4411
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-intro.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xml:id="mcc-intro"><info><title xml:id="mcc-intro-ti1">About the Manual for the Mageia Control Center</title></info>
+
+
+ <para>The Mageia Control Center (MCC) has eight different options or tabs to
+choose from in the left column, and even ten if the drakwizard package was
+installed. Each of these tabs gives a different set of tools that can be
+selected in the big right panel.</para>
+
+ <para>The ten following chapters are about those ten options and the related
+tools.</para>
+
+<para>The last chapter is about some other Mageia tools, that cannot be chosen in
+any of the MCC tabs.</para>
+
+ <para>The titles of the pages will often be the same as the titles of the tool
+screens.</para>
+
+ <para>There is also a search bar available, which you can access by clicking on
+the "Search" tab in the left column.</para>
+
+ </section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-localdisks.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-localdisks.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f07f7467
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-localdisks.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,31 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mcc-localdisks" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-localdisks-ti1">ローカルディスク</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="mcc-localdisks-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="mcc-localdisks.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools to manage or share your
+local disks. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>ローカルディスク</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="drakdisk"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--removable"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--fileshare"></xref></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakdisk.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--removable.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--fileshare.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+ </section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-network.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-network.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..12cd1c4f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-network.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,82 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mcc-network" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-network-ti1">Network and Internet</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="mcc-network.png" xml:id="mcc-network-im1" />
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several network tools. Click on a link
+below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>ネットワークデバイスの管理</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draknetcenter"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakconnect"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakconnect--del"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>ネットワークのカスタマイズと保護</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakproxy"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakgw"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draknetprofile"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakvpn"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist>
+ <title>その他</title>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakhosts"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="draknetcenter.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakconnect.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakconnect--del.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakproxy.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakgw.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="draknetprofile.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakvpn.xml"/>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakhosts.xml"/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networkservices.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networkservices.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..96fe403f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networkservices.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,53 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="mcc-networkservices">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-networkservices-ti1">ネットワークサービス</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-networkservices.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-networkservices-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This screen and the one for <emphasis>Sharing</emphasis> are only visible if
+the <emphasis>drakwizard</emphasis> package is installed. You can choose
+between several tools to set up different servers. Click on a link below or
+on <xref linkend="mcc-sharing"/>to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>ネットワークサービス</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_dhcp"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_bind"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_squid"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_ntp"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_sshd"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_dhcp.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_bind.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_squid.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_ntp.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_sshd.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networksharing.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networksharing.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..3142c9c3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-networksharing.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mcc-networksharing" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-networksharing-ti1">ネットワーク共有</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="mcc-networksharing-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="mcc-networksharing.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools for sharing drives and
+directories. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist><title>Windows(R) 共有の設定</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--smb"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="draksambashare"></xref><emphasis> = Share drives and
+directories with Windows (SMB) systems</emphasis></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist></listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist><title>NFS 共有の設定</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--nfs"></xref></para></listitem>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="draknfs"></xref></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist></listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <orderedlist><title>WebDAV 共有の設定</title>
+ <listitem><para><xref linkend="diskdrake--dav"></xref></para></listitem>
+ </orderedlist></listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--smb.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draksambashare.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--nfs.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draknfs.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="diskdrake--dav.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ </section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-security.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-security.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ea1a1e76
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-security.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="mcc-security">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-security-ti1">セキュリティ</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-security.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-security-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several security tools. Click on a
+link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>セキュリティ</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="msecgui"/><emphasis> = Configure system security, permissions
+and audit</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakfirewall"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draksec"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakinvictus"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakguard"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="msecgui.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakfirewall.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="draksec.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakinvictus.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="drakguard.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-sharing.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-sharing.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..4a41eaa2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-sharing.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="mcc-sharing">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-sharing-ti1">共有</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="mcc-sharing.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="mcc-sharing-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This screen and the one for <emphasis>Network Services</emphasis> are only
+visible if the <emphasis>drakwizard</emphasis> package is installed. You can
+choose between several tools to set up different servers. Click on a link
+below or on <xref linkend="mcc-networkservices"/>to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>共有</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_proftpd"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakwizard_apache2"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_proftpd.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakwizard_apache2.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-system.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-system.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6682a120
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mcc-system.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="mcc-system">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mcc-system-ti1">システム</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="mcc-system.png" xml:id="mcc-system-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several system and administration
+tools. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>システムサービスを管理</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para> <xref linkend="drakauth"></xref> </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakxservices"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakfont"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>ローカライゼーション</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakclock"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="localedrake"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+</listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+
+ <orderedlist><title>管理者用ツール</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="logdrake"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakconsole"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="userdrake"></xref><emphasis> = Manage users on
+system</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="transfugdrake"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="draksnapshot-config"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+</listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakauth.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakxservices.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakfont.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakclock.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="localedrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+ <xi:include href="logdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakconsole.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="userdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="transfugdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="draksnapshot-config.xml"></xi:include>
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mgaapplet-config.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mgaapplet-config.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8baf0a05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mgaapplet-config.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mgaapplet-config" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mgaapplet-config-ti1">更新頻度の設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>mgaapplet-config</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="mgaapplet-config-im1" format="PNG" fileref="mgaapplet-config.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">mgaapplet-config</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Software
+management</emphasis>. It is also available by a <guimenu>right click /
+Updates configuration</guimenu> on the red icon <inlinemediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="MageiaUpdate1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </inlinemediaobject> in the system tray.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+
+ <para>The first slider allows you to change how frequently Mageia will check for
+updates and the second the delay after booting before the first check. The
+check box gives you the option to be warned when a new Mageia release is
+out.</para>
+
+ <para/>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/mousedrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mousedrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..854c24eb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/mousedrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="mousedrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="mousedrake-ti1">マウスとタッチパッドを設定</title>
+
+ <subtitle>mousedrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="mousedrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="mousedrake.png" align="center" format="PNG" />
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">mousedrake</emphasis> as root.</para></footnote> is present in the Mageia
+Control Center under the tab <emphasis role="bold">Hardware</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>As you must have a mouse to install Mageia, that one is already installed by
+Drakinstall. This tool allows installation of another mouse.</para>
+
+ <para>The mice are sorted by connection type and then by model. Select your mouse
+and click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>. Most of the time "Universal / Any
+PS/2 &amp; USB mice" is suitable for a recent mouse. The new mouse is
+immediately taken into account.</para>
+
+ </section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/msecgui.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/msecgui.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..5fbb693d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/msecgui.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,358 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="msecgui">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="msecgui-ti1">MSEC: System Security and Audit</title>
+
+ <subtitle>msecgui</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <!-- written by Lebarhon 2014/01/03 To be checked-->
+<imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="msecgui-im1" revision="1" fileref="msecgui.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Presentation</title>
+
+ <para>msecgui<footnote><para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">msecgui</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is a graphic user interface for
+msec that allows to configure your system security according to two
+approaches:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It sets the system behaviour, msec imposes modifications to the system to
+make it more secure.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>It carries on periodic checks automatically on the system in order to warn
+you if something seems dangerous.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>msec uses the concept of "security levels" which are intended to configure a
+set of system permissions, which can be audited for changes or
+enforcement. Several of them are proposed by Mageia, but you can define your
+own customised security levels.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Overview tab</title>
+
+ <para>See the screenshot above</para>
+
+ <para>The first tab takes up the list of the different security tools with a
+button on the right side to configure them:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Firewall, also found in the MCC / Security / Set up your personal firewall</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Updates, also found in MCC / Software Management / Update your system</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>msec itself with some information:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>enabled or not</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the configured Base security level</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the date of the last Periodic checks and a button to see a detailed report
+and another button to execute the checks just now.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Security settings tab</title>
+
+ <para>A click on the second tab or on the Security
+<guibutton>Configure</guibutton> button leads to the same screen shown
+below.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Basic security tab</title>
+
+ <para role="underline">
+ <emphasis role="underline">Security levels:</emphasis>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>After having checked the box <guilabel>Enable MSEC tool</guilabel>, this tab
+allows you by a double click to choose the security level that appears then
+in bold. If the box is not checked, the level « none » is applied. The
+following levels are available:</para>
+
+ <orderedlist numeration="arabic">
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Level <emphasis role="bold">none</emphasis>. This level is intended if you
+do not want to use msec to control system security, and prefer tuning it on
+your own. It disables all security checks and puts no restrictions or
+constraints on system configuration and settings. Please use this level only
+if you are knowing what you are doing, as it would leave your system
+vulnerable to attack.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Level <emphasis role="bold">standard</emphasis>. This is the default
+configuration when installed and is intended for casual users. It
+constrains several system settings and executes daily security checks which
+detect changes in system files, system accounts, and vulnerable directory
+permissions. (This level is similar to levels 2 and 3 from past msec
+versions).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Level <emphasis role="bold">secure</emphasis>. This level is intended when
+you want to ensure your system is secure, yet usable. It further restricts
+system permissions and executes more periodic checks. Moreover, access to
+the system is more restricted. (This level is similar to levels 4 (High) and
+5 (Paranoid) from old msec versions).</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Besides those levels, different task-oriented security are also provided,
+such as the <emphasis role="bold">fileserver </emphasis>, <emphasis
+role="bold">webserver</emphasis> and <emphasis
+role="bold">netbook</emphasis> levels. Such levels attempt to pre-configure
+system security according to the most common use cases.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>The last two levels called <emphasis role="bold">audit_daily </emphasis> and
+<emphasis role="bold">audit_weekly</emphasis> are not really security levels
+but rather tools for periodic checks only.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <para>These levels are saved in
+<filename>etc/security/msec/level.&lt;levelname></filename>. You can define
+your own customised security levels, saving them into specific files called
+<filename>level.&lt;levelname></filename>, placed into the folder
+<filename>etc/security/msec/.</filename> This function is intended for power
+users which require a customised or more secure system configuration.</para>
+
+ <caution>
+ <para>Keep in mind that user-modified parameters take precedence over default
+level settings.</para>
+ </caution>
+
+ <para>
+ <emphasis role="underline">Security alerts:</emphasis>
+ </para>
+
+ <para>If you check the box <guibutton>Send security alerts by email
+to:</guibutton>, the security alerts generated by msec are going to be sent
+by local e-mail to the security administrator named in the nearby field. You
+can fill either a local user or a complete e-mail address (the local e-mail
+and the e-mail manager must be set accordingly). At last, you can receive
+the security alerts directly on your desktop. Check the relevant box to
+enable it.</para>
+
+ <important>
+ <para>It is strongly advisable to enable the security alerts option in order to
+immediately inform the security administrator of possible security
+problems. If not, the administrator will have to regularly check the logs
+files available in <filename>/var/log/security.</filename></para></important>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="underline">Security options:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Creating a customised level is not the only way to customise the computer
+security, it is also possible to use the tabs presented here after to change
+any option you want. Current configuration for msec is stored in
+<filename>/etc/security/msec/security.conf</filename>. This file contains
+the current security level name and the list of all the modifications done
+to the options.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>System security tab</title>
+
+ <para>This tab displays all the security options on the left side column, a
+description in the centre column, and their current values on the right side
+column.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>To modify an option, double click on it and a new window appears (see
+screenshot below). It displays the option name, a short description, the
+actual and default values, and a drop down list where the new value can be
+selected. Click on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> button to validate the
+choice.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui11.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <caution>
+ <para>Do not forget when leaving msecgui to save definitively your configuration
+using the menu <guimenu>File -> Save the configuration</guimenu>. If you
+have changed the settings, msecgui allows you to preview the changes before
+saving them.</para>
+ </caution>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui10.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Network security</title>
+
+ <para>This tab displays all the network options and works like the previous tab</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Periodic checks tab</title>
+
+ <para>Periodic checks aim to inform the security administrator by means of
+security alerts of all situations msec thinks potentially dangerous.</para>
+
+ <para>This tab displays all the periodic checks done by msec and their frequency
+if the box <guibutton>Enable periodic security checks</guibutton> is
+checked. Changes are done like in the previous tabs.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>Exceptions tab</title>
+
+ <para>Sometimes alert messages are due to well known and wanted situations. In
+these cases they are useless and wasted time for the administrator. This tab
+allows you to create as many exceptions as you want to avoid unwanted alert
+messages. It is obviously empty at the first msec start. The screenshot
+below shows four exceptions.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>To create an exception, click on the <guibutton>Add a rule</guibutton>
+button</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Select the wanted periodic check in the drop down list called
+<guilabel>Check</guilabel> and then, enter the
+<guilabel>Exception</guilabel> in the text area. Adding an exception is
+obviously not definitive, you can either delete it using the
+<guibutton>Delete</guibutton> button of the <guilabel>Exceptions</guilabel>
+tab or modify it with a double clicK.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>権限</title>
+ <para>This tab is intended for file and directory permissions checking and
+enforcement.</para>
+ <para>Like for the security, msec owns different permissions levels (standard,
+secure, ..), they are enabled accordingly with the chosen security
+level. You can create your own customised permissions levels, saving them
+into specific files called <filename>perm.&lt;levelname> </filename> placed
+into the folder <filename>etc/security/msec/</filename> . This function is
+intended for power users which require a customised configuration. It is
+also possible to use the tab presented here after to change any permission
+you want. Current configuration is stored in
+<filename>/etc/security/msec/perms.conf.</filename> This file contains the
+list of all the modifications done to the permissions.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>Default permissions are visible as a list of rules (a rule per line). You
+can see on the left side, the file or folder concerned by the rule, then the
+owner, then the group and then the permissions given by the rule. If, for a
+given rule:</para>
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the box <guilabel>Enforce</guilabel> is not checked, msec only checks if the
+defined permissions for this rule are respected and sends an alert message
+if not, but does not change anything.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>the box <guilabel>Enforce</guilabel> is checked, then msec will rule the
+permissions respect at the first periodic check and overwrite the
+permissions.</para></listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ <important><para>For this to work, the option CHECK_PERMS in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Periodic check tab</emphasis> must be configured accordingly.</para></important><para>To create a new rule, click on the <guibutton> Add a rule</guibutton> button
+and fill the fields as shown in the example below. The joker * is allowed in
+the <guilabel>File</guilabel> field. “current” means no modification.</para>
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="msecgui9.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ <para>Click on the <guibutton>OK</guibutton> button to validate the choice and do
+not forget when leaving to save definitively your configuration using the
+menu <guimenu>File -> Save the configuration</guimenu>. If you have changed
+the settings, msecgui allows you to preview the changes before saving them. </para>
+ <note><para>It is also possible to create or modify the rules by editing the
+configuration file <filename>/etc/security/msec/perms.conf</filename>.
+ </para></note>
+ <caution><para>Changes in the <emphasis role="bold">Permission tab</emphasis> (or directly
+in the configuration file) are taken into account at the first periodic
+check (see the option CHECK_PERMS in the <emphasis role="bold">Periodic
+checks tab</emphasis>). If you want them to be taken immediately into
+account, use the msecperms command in a console with root rights. You can
+use before, the msecperms -p command to know the permissions that will be
+changed by msecperms.</para></caution>
+ <caution><para>Do not forget that if you modify the permissions in a console or in a file
+manager, for a file where the box <guilabel>Enforce </guilabel> is checked
+in the <emphasis role="bold">Permissions tab </emphasis>, msecgui will write
+the old permissions back after a while, accordingly to the configuration of
+the options CHECK_PERMS and CHECK_PERMS_ENFORCE in the <emphasis
+role="bold">Periodic Checks tab </emphasis>.</para></caution>
+ </section>
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/otherMageiaTools.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/otherMageiaTools.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..0fd3b946
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/otherMageiaTools.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,42 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="otherMageiaTools">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="otherMageiaTools-ti1">Other Mageia Tools</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>There are more Mageia tools than those that can be started in the Mageia
+Control Center. Click on a link below to learn more, or continue reading the
+next pages.</para>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakbug"/><emphasis>drakbug</emphasis>
+ </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakbug_report"/><emphasis>drakbug_report </emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="lsnetdrake"/><emphasis>TO BE WRITTEN </emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="lspcidrake"/></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>And more tools?</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakbug.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="drakbug_report.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="lsnetdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+ <xi:include href="lspcidrake.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/rpmdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/rpmdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..b05483f3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/rpmdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,251 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="rpmdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+ <!--2012-09-03 marja expanded xml:id's of section and title below, because they conflicted with identical xml:id's in another page of MCC help, also replaced first para in some sections with title tags, removed figure tags-->
+<info annotations="simonnzg 6jan2013">
+ <title xml:id="rpmdrake-ti1">Software Management (Install and Remove Software)</title>
+
+ <subtitle>rpmdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="rpmdrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="rpmdrake.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+
+
+ <section xml:id="rpmdrake-introduction">
+ <title xml:id="rpmdrake-introduction-ti1">Introduction to rpmdrake</title>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">rpmdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote>, also known as drakrpm, is a
+program for installing, uninstalling and updating packages. It is the
+graphical user interface of URPMI. At each start up, it will check online
+package lists (called 'media') downloaded straight from Mageia's official
+servers, and will show you each time the latest applications and packages
+available for your computer. A filter system allows you to display only
+certain types of packages: you may display only installed applications (by
+default), or only available updates. You can also view only not installed
+packages. You can also search by the name of a package, or in the summaries
+of descriptions or in the full descriptions of packages or in the file names
+included in the packages.</para>
+
+ <para>To work, rpmdrake needs the repositories to be configured with <xref
+linkend="drakrpm-edit-media"/> .</para>
+
+ <important>
+ <para>During the installation, the configured repository is the medium used for
+the installation, generally the DVD or CD. If you keep this medium, rpmdrake
+will ask it each time you want to install a package, with this pop-up window
+: <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrake8.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>If the above message annoys you
+and you have a good internet connection without too strict download limit,
+it is wise to remove that medium and replace it by online repositories
+thanks to <xref linkend="drakrpm-edit-media"/> .</para>
+
+ <para>Moreover, the online repositories are always up to date, contains much more
+packages, and allow to update your installed packages.</para>
+ </important>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The main parts of the screen</title>
+
+ <screenshot>
+<mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></screenshot>
+
+ <orderedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Package type filter:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This filter allows you to display only certain types of packages. The first
+time you start the manager, it only displays applications with a graphical
+interface. You can display either all the packages and all their
+dependencies and libraries or only package groups such as applications only,
+updates only or backported packages from newer versions of Mageia.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>The default filter setting is for new entrants to Linux or Mageia, who
+probably do not want command line or specialist tools. Since you're reading
+this documentation, you're obviously interested in improving your knowledge
+of Mageia, so it is best to set this filter to "All".</para>
+ </warning>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><firstterm> <emphasis role="bold">Package state filter:</emphasis>
+</firstterm></para>
+
+ <para>This filter allows you to view only the installed packages, only the
+packages that are not installed or all of the packages, both installed and
+not installed.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Search mode:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Click on this icon to search through the package names, through their
+summaries, through their complete description or through the files included
+in the packages.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">"Find" box:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Enter here one or more key words. If you want to use more than one keyword
+for searching use '|' between keywords, e.g. To search for "mplayer" and
+"xine" at the same time type 'mplayer | xine'.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Erase all:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This icon can erase in one click all the key words entered in the "Find" box
+.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Categories list:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This side bar groups all applications and packages into clear categories and
+sub categories.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Description panel:</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>This panel displays the package's name, its summary and complete
+description. It displays many useful elements about the selected package. It
+can also show precise details about the package, the files included in the
+package as well as a list of the last changes made by the maintainer.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The status column</title>
+
+ <para>Once you correctly set the filters, you can find your software either by
+category (in area 6 above) or by name/summary/description using area 4. A
+list of packages fulfilling your query and, don't forget, the chosen medium
+is shown with different status markers according to whether each package is
+installed/not installed/an update... To change this status, just check or
+uncheck the box before the package name and click on
+<guibutton>Apply</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para><table>
+ <title/>
+
+ <tgroup cols="2" align="left">
+ <colspec align="center"/>
+
+ <thead>
+ <row>
+ <entry align="center">アイコン</entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle" align="center">Legend</entry>
+ </row>
+ </thead>
+
+ <tbody>
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package is already installed</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package will be installed</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package cannot be modified</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package is an update</entry>
+ </row>
+
+ <row>
+ <entry><mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="../rpmdrake6.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></entry>
+
+ <entry valign="middle">This package will be uninstalled</entry>
+ </row>
+ </tbody>
+ </tgroup>
+ </table></para>
+
+ <para>Examples in the screenshot above:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If I uncheck digikam (the green arrow tell us it is installed), the status
+icon will go red with an up arrow and it will be uninstalled when clicking
+on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>If I check qdigidoc (which is not installed, see the status), the orange
+with a down arrow status icon will appear and it will be installed when
+clicking on <guibutton>Apply</guibutton>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title>The dependencies</title>
+
+ <screenshot>
+<mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="rpmdrake7.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></screenshot>
+
+ <para>Some packages need other packages called dependencies in order to work. They
+are for example libraries or tools. In this case, Rpmdrake displays an
+information window allowing you to choose whether to accept the selected
+dependencies, cancel the operation or get more information (see above). It
+may also happen that various packages are able to provide the needed
+library, in which case rpmdrake displays the list of alternatives with a
+button to get more information and another button to choose which package to
+install.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/scannerdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/scannerdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..c8f3583b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/scannerdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,259 @@
+<?xml version="1.0" encoding="utf-8"?>
+<section version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="scannerdrake"
+ xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook"
+ xmlns:xlink="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink"
+ xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML"
+ xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg"
+ xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml"
+ xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerdrake-ti1">スキャナを設定</title>
+ <subtitle>scannerdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+
+
+ <section xml:id="scannerinstallation">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerinstallation-ti1">インストール</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>This tool <footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing
+<emphasis>scannerdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> allows you to configure a
+single scanner device or a multifunction device which includes scanning. It
+also allows you to share local devices connected to this computer with a
+remote computer or to access remote scanners.</para>
+
+ <para>When you start this tool for the first time, you may get the following
+message:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>"SANE packages need to be installed to use scanners</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>Do you want to install the SANE packages?"</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Choose <emphasis>Yes</emphasis> to continue. It will install
+<code>scanner-gui</code> and <code>task-scanning</code> if they are not yet
+installed.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im1"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If your scanner is identified correctly, so if in the above screen you see
+the name of your scanner, the scanner is ready for use with, for instance,
+<emphasis>XSane</emphasis> or <emphasis>Simple Scan</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>In that case, you might now want to want to configure the <emphasis>Scanner
+sharing</emphasis> option. You can read about it in the <xref
+linkend="scannersharing"/>.</para>
+
+
+ <para>However, if your scanner hasn't been correctly identified, and checking its
+cable(s) and power switch and then pressing <emphasis>Search for new
+scanners</emphasis> doesn't help, you'll need to press <emphasis>Add a
+scanner manually</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>Choose the brand of your scanner in the list you see, then its type from the
+list for that brand and click <emphasis>Ok</emphasis></para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake2.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im2"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you can't find your scanner in the list, then click
+<emphasis>Cancel</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Please check whether your scanner is supported on the <link
+xlink:href="http://www.sane-project.org/lists/sane-mfgs-cvs.html">SANE:
+Supported Devices</link> page and ask for help in the <link
+xlink:href="http://forums.mageia.org/en/">forums</link>.</para>
+ </note>
+
+<figure xml:id="choosescannerport">
+<info>
+ <title xml:id="choosescannerport-ti1">Choose port</title>
+ </info> <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake3.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im3"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject></figure>
+
+ <para>You can leave this setting to <emphasis>Auto-detect available
+ports</emphasis> unless your scanner's interface is a parallel port. In that
+case, select <emphasis>/dev/parport0</emphasis> if you have only one.</para>
+
+ <para>After clicking <emphasis>Ok</emphasis>, in most cases you will see a screen
+similar to the one below.</para>
+<para>If you don't get that screen, then please read the <xref
+linkend="scannerextrasteps"/>.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake4.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im4"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="scannersharing">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannersharing-ti2">Scannersharing</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake5.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im5"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Here you can choose whether the scanners connected to this machine should be
+accessible by remote machines and by which remote machines. You can also
+decide here whether scanners on remote machines should be made available on
+this machine.</para>
+
+ <para>Scanner sharing to hosts : name or IP address of hosts can be added or
+deleted from the list of hosts allowed to access the local device(s), on
+this computer.</para>
+
+ <para>Usage of remote scanners : name or IP address of hosts can added or deleted
+from the list of hosts which give access to a remote scanner.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake6.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im6"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Scanner sharing to hosts: you can add host.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake7.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im7"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Scanner sharing to hosts: specify which host(s) to add, or allow all remote
+machines.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake8.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im8"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>"All remote machines" are allowed to access the local scanner.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata align="center" fileref="scannerdrake9.png"
+ format="PNG" revision="1"
+ xml:id="scannerdrake-im9"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>If the package <emphasis>saned</emphasis> is not yet installed, the tool
+offers to do it.</para>
+
+ <para>At the end, the tool will alter these files:</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>/etc/sane.d/saned.conf</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>/etc/sane.d/net.conf</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis>/etc/sane.d/dll.conf </emphasis>to add or comment the directive
+"net"</para>
+
+ <para>It will also configure <emphasis>saned</emphasis> and
+<emphasis>xinetd</emphasis> to be started on boot.</para>
+ </section>
+
+<section xml:id="scannerspecifics">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerspecifics-ti2">Specifics</title>
+ </info>
+
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Hewlett-Packard</para>
+
+ <para>Most HP scanners are managed from <emphasis>HP Device Manager</emphasis>
+(hplip) which also manages printers. In this case, this tool does not allow
+you to configure it and invites you to use <emphasis>HP Device
+Manager</emphasis>.</para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Epson</para>
+
+ <para>Drivers are available from <link
+xlink:href="http://download.ebz.epson.net/dsc/search/01/search/?OSC=LX">this
+page</link>. When indicated, you must install the
+<emphasis>iscan-data</emphasis> package first, then
+<emphasis>iscan</emphasis> (in this order). It is possible that the
+<emphasis>iscan</emphasis> package will generate a warning about a conflict
+with <emphasis>sane</emphasis>. Users have reported that this warning can be
+ignored.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+</section>
+
+<section xml:id="scannerextrasteps">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="scannerextrasteps-ti1">Extra installation steps</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <para>It is possible that after selecting a port for your scanner in the <xref
+linkend="choosescannerport"/> screen, you need to take one or more extra
+steps to correctly configure your scanner.</para>
+
+<itemizedlist>
+
+ <listitem>
+<para>In some cases, you're told the scanner needs its firmware to be uploaded
+each time it is started. This tool allows you to load it into the device,
+after you installed it on your system. In this screen you can install the
+firmware from a CD or a Windows installation, or install the one you
+downloaded from an Internet site of the vendor.</para><para>
+ When your device's firmware needs to be loaded, it can take a long time at
+each first usage, possibly more than one minute. So be patient.</para>
+</listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+<para>Also, you may get a screen telling you to adjust the
+<emphasis>/etc/sane.d/"name_of_your_SANE_backend".conf file.</emphasis> </para>
+ </listitem>
+
+<listitem>
+<para>Read those or other instructions you get carefully and if you don't know
+what to do, feel free to ask for help in the <link
+xlink:href="http://forums.mageia.org/en/">forums</link>.</para>
+</listitem>
+
+</itemizedlist>
+
+ </section>
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/software-management.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/software-management.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1b8e4b35
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/software-management.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?>
+<section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:xi="http://www.w3.org/2001/XInclude" xmlns:ns6="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja"
+xml:id="software-management">
+ <info>
+ <title xml:id="software-management-ti1">ソフトウェアの管理</title>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="software-management-im1" revision="1" align="center" format="PNG" fileref="software-management.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>In this screen you can choose between several tools for software
+management. Click on a link below to learn more.</para>
+ <orderedlist><title>ソフトウェアの管理</title>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="rpmdrake"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="MageiaUpdate"></xref><emphasis> = Update your
+system</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="mgaapplet-config"></xref></para>
+ </listitem>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><xref linkend="drakrpm-edit-media"></xref><emphasis> = Configure media
+sources for install and update</emphasis></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </orderedlist>
+
+ <xi:include href="rpmdrake.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="MageiaUpdate.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="mgaapplet-config.xml"></xi:include>
+ <xi:include href="drakrpm-edit-media.xml"></xi:include>
+
+
+</section>
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/system-config-printer.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/system-config-printer.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..8c1551da
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/system-config-printer.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,341 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="system-config-printer">
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Language proof JohnR 2012/08/28 -->
+<!-- 2012-09-03 marja: made the link to Complete the installation process work (I hope)
+ Lebarhon : added All in one devices in the chapter "Hewlett-Packard printers" 12/13-->
+<title xml:id="system-config-printer-ti1">Install and configure a printer</title>
+
+ <subtitle>system-config-printer</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata revision="1" align="center" xml:id="system-config-printer-im1" format="PNG" fileref="system-config-printer.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <section xml:id="introduction">
+ <title xml:id="introduction-ti1">序文</title>
+
+ <para>Printing is managed on Mageia by a server named CUPS. It has its own <link
+ns2:title="CUPS" ns2:href="http://localhost:631">configuration
+interface</link> which is accessible via an Internet browser, but Mageia
+offers its own tool for installing printers called system-config-printer
+which is shared with other distributions such as Fedora, Mandriva, Ubuntu
+and openSUSE.</para>
+
+ <para>You should enable the non-free repository before proceeding with the
+installation, because some drivers may only be available in this way.</para>
+
+ <para>Printer installation is carried out in the <guilabel>Hardware</guilabel>
+section of the Mageia Control Centre. Select the <guilabel>Configure
+printing and scanning</guilabel> tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing
+<emphasis>system-config-printer</emphasis>. The root password will be asked
+for.</para>
+ </footnote>.</para>
+
+ <para>MCC will ask for the installation two packages:</para>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <para>task-printing-server</para>
+
+ <para>task-printing-hp</para>
+ </blockquote>
+
+ <para>It is necessary to accept this installation to continue. Up to 230MB of
+dependencies are needed.</para>
+
+ <para>To add a printer, choose the "Add" printer button. The system will try to
+detect any printers and the ports available. The screenshot displays a
+printer connected to a parallel port. If a printer is detected, such as a
+printer on a USB port, it will be displayed on the first line. The window
+will also attempt to configure a network printer.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="automatic">
+ <title>Automatically detected printer</title>
+
+ <para>This usually refers to USB printers. The utility automatically finds the
+name of the printer and displays it. Select the printer and then click
+"Next". If there is a known driver associated for the printer, it will be
+automatically installed. If there is more than one driver or no known
+drivers, a window will ask you to select or furnish one, as explained in the
+next paragraph. Continue with <xref linkend="terminate"/></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="non_automatic">
+ <title>No automatically detected printer</title>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="printer3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>When you select a port, the system loads a driver list and displays a window
+to select a driver. The choice can be made through one of the following
+options.</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Select printer from database</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>provide PPD file</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>search for a driver to download</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>By selecting from the database, the window suggests a printer manufacturer
+first, and then a device and a driver associated with it. If more than one
+driver is suggested, select one which is recommended, unless you have
+encountered some problems with that one before, in this case select the one
+which know to work.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="terminate">
+ <title>Complete the installation process</title>
+
+ <para>After the driver selection, a window requests some information which will
+allow the system to designate and discover the printer. The first line is
+the name under which the device will appear in applications in the list of
+available printers. The installer then suggests printing a test page. After
+this step, the printer is added and appears in the list of available
+printers.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="network_printer">
+ <title>Network printer</title>
+
+ <para>Network printers are printers that are attached directly to a wired or
+wireless network, that are attached to a printserver or that are attached to
+another workstation that serves as printserver.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Often, it is better to configure the DHCP server to always associate a fixed
+IP address with the printer's MAC-address. Of course that should be the same
+as the IP address the printer of printserver is set to, if it has a fixed
+one.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para>The printer's Mac-address is a serial number given to the printer or
+printserver or computer it is attached to, that can be obtained from a
+configuration page printed by the printer or which may be written on a label
+on the printer or printserver. If your shared printer is attached to a
+Mageia system, you can run <emphasis><code>ifconfig</code></emphasis> on it
+as root to find the MAC-address. It is the sequence of numbers and letters
+after "HWaddr".</para>
+
+ <para>You can add your network printer by choosing the protocol it uses to talk to
+your computer over the network. If you don't know which protocol to choose,
+you can try the <guilabel>Network Printer</guilabel> - <guilabel>Find
+Network Printer</guilabel> option in the <guilabel>Devices</guilabel> menu
+and give the IP address of the printer in the box on the right, where it
+says "host".</para>
+
+ <para>If the tool recognises your printer or printserver, it will propose a
+protocol and a queue, but you can choose a more appropriate one from the
+list below it or give the correct queue name if it isn't in the list.</para>
+
+ <para>Look in the documentation that came with your printer or printserver to find
+which protocol(s) it supports and for possible specific queue names.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="network_printing_protocols">
+ <title>Network printing protocols</title>
+
+ <para>One current technique is one developed by Hewlett-Packard and known as
+JetDirect. It allows access to a printer directly connected to the network
+via an Ethernet port. You must know the IP-address at which the printer is
+known on the network. This technique is also used inside some ADSL-routers
+which contain an USB port to connect the printer. In this case, the
+IP-address is that of the router. Note that the tool "Hp Device manager" can
+manage dynamically configured IP-adress, setting an URI like
+<emphasis>hp:/net/&lt;name-of-the-printer></emphasis> . In this case, fixed
+IP-adress is not required.</para>
+
+ <para>Choose the option <guilabel>AppSocket/HP JetDirect</guilabel> as the
+protocol and set the address in <guilabel>Host:</guilabel>, do not change
+the <guilabel>Port Number</guilabel>, unless you know that it needs to be
+changed. After the selection of the protocol, the selection of the driver is
+the same as above.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="printer5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The other protocols are:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (ipp)</emphasis>: a printer which can
+be accessed on a TCP/IP network via the IPP protocol, for example a printer
+connected to a station using CUPS. This protocol may also be used also by
+some ADSL-routers.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (https): </emphasis>the same as ipp,
+but using http transport and with TLS secured protocol. The port has to be
+defined. By default, the port 631 is used.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Internet Printing Protocol (ipps): </emphasis>the same as ipp, but
+with TLS secured protocol.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>LPD/LPR host or Printer</emphasis>: a printer which can be
+accessed on a TCP/IP network via the LPD protocol, for example a printer
+connected to a station using LPD.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para><emphasis>Windows printer via SAMBA</emphasis>: a printer connected to a
+station running Windows or a SMB server and shared.</para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>The URI can also be added directly. Here are some examples on how to form
+the URI:</para>
+
+ <itemizedlist>
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Appsocket</para>
+
+ <para><uri>socket://ip-address-or-hostname:port </uri></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Internet Printing Protocol (IPP)</para>
+
+ <para><uri>ipp://ip-address-or-hostname:port-number/resource</uri></para>
+
+ <para><uri>http://ip-address-or-hostname:port-number/resource</uri></para>
+ </listitem>
+
+ <listitem>
+ <para>Line Printer Daemon (LPD) Protocol</para>
+
+ <para><uri>lpd://username@ip-address-or-hostname/queue</uri></para>
+ </listitem>
+ </itemizedlist>
+
+ <para>Additional information can be found in the <link
+ns2:href="http://www.cups.org/documentation.php/doc-1.5/network.html">CUPS
+documentation.</link></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="properties">
+ <title>Device Properties</title>
+
+ <para>You can access the properties of the device. The menu allows access to
+parameters for the CUPS server. By default a CUPS server is launched on your
+system, but you can specify a different one with the
+<guimenu>Server</guimenu> | <guimenuitem>Connect...</guimenuitem> menu,
+another window which gives access to the tuning of other specific parameters
+of the server, following <guimenu>Server</guimenu> |
+<guimenuitem>Settings.</guimenuitem></para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section>
+ <title xml:id="troubleshoot">Troubleshoot</title>
+
+ <para>You can find some information on occurring errors during printing by
+inspecting <filename>/var/log/cups/error_log</filename></para>
+
+ <para>You can also access to a tool to diagnose problems using the
+<guimenu>Help</guimenu> | <guilabel>Troubleshoot</guilabel> menu.</para>
+ </section>
+
+ <section xml:id="specificities">
+ <title>Specifics</title>
+
+ <para>It is possible that some drivers for specific printers are not available in
+Mageia or are not functional. In this case, have a look at the <link
+ns2:href="http://openprinting.org/printers/">openprinting</link> site to
+check if a driver for your device is available. If yes, check if the package
+is already present in Mageia and in this case install it manually. Then,
+redo the installation process to configure the printer. In all cases, report
+the problem in bugzilla or on the forum if you are comfortable with this
+tool and furnish the model and driver information and whether the printer
+works or not after installation. Here are some sources to find other
+up-to-date drivers or for more recent devices.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Brother printers</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><link
+ns2:href="http://welcome.solutions.brother.com/bsc/public_s/id/linux/en/download_prn.html">This
+page</link> give a list of drivers provided by Brother. Search the driver
+for your device, download the rpm(s) and install.</para>
+
+ <para>You should install Brother drivers before running the configuration utility.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Hewlett-Packard printers and All in one
+devices</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>These devices use the hplip tool. It is installed automatically after the
+detection or the selection of the printer. You can find other information
+<link
+ns2:href="http://hplipopensource.com/hplip-web/index.html">here</link>. The
+tool "HP Device Manager" is available in the <guilabel>System</guilabel>
+menu. Also view <link
+ns2:href="http://hplipopensource.com/hplip-web/install/manual/hp_setup.html">configuration</link>
+for the management of the printer.</para>
+
+ <para>A HP All in one device must be installed as a printer and the scanner
+features will be added. Note that sometimes, the Xsane interface doesn't
+allow to scan films or slides (the lighting slid can't operate). In this
+case, it is possible to scan, using the standalone mode, and save the
+picture on a memory card or USB stick inserted in the device. Afterwards,
+open your favourite imaging software and load your picture from the memory
+card which is appeared in the /media folder.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Samsung colour printer</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>For specific Samsung and Xerox colour printers, <link
+ns2:href="http://foo2qpdl.rkkda.com/">this site provides drivers</link> for
+the QPDL protocol.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Epson printers and scanners</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Drivers for Epson printers are available from <link
+ns2:href="http://download.ebz.epson.net/dsc/search/01/search/?OSC=LX">this
+search page</link>. For the scanner part, you must install the "iscan-data"
+package first, then "iscan" (in this order). A iscan-plugin package can also
+be available and is to install. Choose the <emphasis>rpm</emphasis> packages
+according to your architecture. </para>
+
+ <para> It is possible that the iscan package will generate a warning about a
+conflict with sane. Users have reported that this warning can be ignored.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Canon printers</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>For Canon printers, it may be advisable to install a tool named turboprint
+<link ns2:href="http://www.turboprint.info/">available here </link>.</para>
+ </section>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/transfugdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/transfugdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..6751a25b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/transfugdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,138 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xml:id="transfugdrake" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Written by yurchor 2013-07-03 -->
+<!-- Tproof -->
+<!-- -->
+<title xml:id="transfugdrake-ti1">Windows® のドキュメントと設定をインポート</title>
+
+ <subtitle>transfugdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="transfugdrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="transfugdrake.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">transfugdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the <emphasis
+role="bold">System</emphasis> tab in the Mageia Control Center labeled
+<guilabel>Import Windows(TM) documents and settings</guilabel></para>
+
+ <para>The tool allows an administrator to import the user documents and settings
+from a <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> 2000, <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark> XP or <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark> <trademark>Vista</trademark>
+installation on the same computer as the Mageia installation.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Please note that all the changes will be applied by transfugdrake
+immediately after pressing <guibutton>Next</guibutton>.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>After starting transfugdrake you will see the first wizard page with some
+explanation about the tool and import options.</para>
+
+ <para>As soon as you read and understand the instructions, press the
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. This should run a detection of
+<trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> installation.</para>
+
+ <para>When the detection step is complete you will see a page which allows you to
+choose accounts in <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> and
+Mageia for the import procedure. It is possible to choose other user account
+than yours own.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Please take into account that due to migrate-assistant (the backend of
+transfugdrake) limitations <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark>
+user account names with special symbols can be displayed incorrectly.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>Migration may take some time depending on the size of the document folders.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>Some <trademark class="registered">Windows</trademark> applications
+(especially drivers) may create user accounts for different purposes. For
+example, NVidia drivers in <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark>are updated using
+<emphasis>UpdatusUser</emphasis>. Please do not use such accounts for the
+import purposes.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para>When you finished with the accounts selection press
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method
+to import documents:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Transfugdrake is designed to import <trademark
+class="registered">Windows</trademark> data from <emphasis>My
+Documents</emphasis>, <emphasis>My Music</emphasis> and <emphasis>My
+Pictures</emphasis> folders. It is possible to skip import by selecting the
+appropriate item in this window.</para>
+
+ <para>When you finished with the document import method choosing press
+<guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method
+to import bookmarks:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Transfugdrake can import <emphasis>Internet Explorer</emphasis> and
+<emphasis>Mozilla Firefox</emphasis> bookmarks into the bookmarks of Mageia
+<emphasis>Mozilla Firefox</emphasis> instance.</para>
+
+ <para>Choose the preferred import option and press the <guibutton>Next</guibutton>
+button.</para>
+
+
+
+ <!-- Does not work as expected, might be due to incompatible version of OE
+ <para>
+With transfugdrake, it is possible to import <emphasis>Outlook Express</emphasis> settings and mail archives into <emphasis>Evolution</emphasis>.</para>
+
+ <para>When you finished with the mail import method choosing press <guibutton>Next</guibutton> button. The next page is used to select a method to import mail:</para>
+-->
+<para>The next page allows you to import desktop background:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake4.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>Choose the preferred option and press the <guibutton>Next</guibutton>
+button.</para>
+
+ <para>The last page of wizard shows some congratulation message. Just press the
+<guibutton>Finish</guibutton> button.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="transfugdrake5.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file
diff --git a/docs/mcc-help/ja/userdrake.xml b/docs/mcc-help/ja/userdrake.xml
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..dfda84f0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/docs/mcc-help/ja/userdrake.xml
@@ -0,0 +1,154 @@
+<?xml version='1.0' encoding='utf-8'?><section xmlns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" xmlns:ns5="http://www.w3.org/1998/Math/MathML" xmlns:ns4="http://www.w3.org/2000/svg" xmlns:ns3="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xmlns:ns2="http://www.w3.org/1999/xlink" xmlns:ns="http://docbook.org/ns/docbook" version="5.0" xml:lang="ja" xml:id="userdrake">
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+ <info>
+ <!-- Written AM desmottes (lebarhon) 2012-08-27 -->
+<!-- Tproof -->
+<!-- Preliminary lproof JohnR 2012-08-30 -->
+<!-- -->
+<title xml:id="userdrake-ti1">ユーザとグループ</title>
+
+ <subtitle>userdrake</subtitle>
+ </info>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata xml:id="userdrake-im1" revision="1" fileref="userdrake.png" align="center" format="PNG"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>This tool<footnote>
+ <para>You can start this tool from the command line, by typing <emphasis
+role="bold">userdrake</emphasis> as root.</para>
+ </footnote> is found under the <emphasis
+role="bold">System</emphasis> tab in the Mageia Control Center labelled
+"Manage users on system"</para>
+
+ <para>The tool allows an administrator to manage the users and the groups, this
+means to add or delete a user or group and to modify user and group settings
+(ID, shell, ...)</para>
+
+ <para>When userdrake is opened, all the users existing on the system are listed in
+the <guibutton>Users</guibutton> tab, and all the groups in the
+<guibutton>Groups</guibutton> tab. Both tabs operate the same way.</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>1 Add User</guibutton></para>
+
+ <para>This button opens a new window with all fields shown empty:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="userdrake1.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The field <emphasis role="bold">Full Name</emphasis> is intended for the
+entry of a family name and first name, but it is possible to write anything
+or nothing as well!</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Login</emphasis> is the only required field.</para>
+
+ <para>Setting a <emphasis role="bold">Password</emphasis> is highly
+recommended. There is a little shield on the right, if it is red, the
+password is weak, too short or is too similar to the login name. You should
+use figures, lower and upper case characters, punctuation marks, etc. The
+shield will turn orange and then green as the password strength improves.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Confirm Password</emphasis> field is there to ensure
+you entered what you intended to.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Login Shell </emphasis>is a drop down list that allows
+you to change the shell used by the user you are adding, the options are
+Bash, Dash and Sh.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Create a private group for the user</emphasis>, if
+checked will automatically create a group with the same name and the new
+user as the only member (this may be edited).</para>
+
+ <para>The other options should be obvious. The new user is created immediately
+after you click on <guibutton>OK</guibutton>.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">2 Add Group</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>You only need to enter the new group name, and if required, the specific
+group ID.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">3 Edit</emphasis> (a selected user)</para>
+
+ <para><guibutton>User Data</guibutton>: Allows you to modify all the data given
+for the user at creation (the ID can't be changed).</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Account Info</emphasis>:</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="userdrake2.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para>The first option is for setting an expiration date for the account.
+Connection is impossible after this date. This is useful for temporary
+accounts.</para>
+
+ <para>The second option is to lock the account, connection is impossible as long
+as the account is locked.</para>
+
+ <para>It is also possible to change the icon.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Password Info</emphasis>: Allows you to set an
+expiration date for the password, this forces the user to change his
+password periodically.</para>
+
+ <mediaobject>
+ <imageobject>
+ <imagedata fileref="userdrake3.png"/>
+ </imageobject>
+ </mediaobject>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Group</emphasis>: Here you can select the groups that
+the user is a member of.</para>
+
+ <note>
+ <para>If you are modifying a connected user account, modifications will not be
+effective until his/her next login.</para>
+ </note>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">4 Edit</emphasis> (with a group selected)</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Group Data</emphasis>: Allows you to modify the group
+name.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">Group Users</emphasis>: Here you can select the users
+who are members of the group</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">5 Delete</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>Select a user or a group and click on <emphasis
+role="bold">Delete</emphasis> to remove it. For a user, a window appears to
+ask if home directory and mailbox must also be deleted. If a private group
+has been created for the user, it will be deleted as well.</para>
+
+ <warning>
+ <para>It is possible to delete a group which is not empty.</para>
+ </warning>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">6 Refresh</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para>The User database can be changed outside of Userdrake. Click on this icon to
+refresh the display.</para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">7 Guest Account</emphasis></para>
+
+ <para><emphasis role="bold">guest</emphasis> is a special account. It is intended
+to give somebody temporary access to the system with total security. Login
+is xguest, there is no password, and it is impossible to make modifications
+to the system from this account. The personal directories are deleted at the
+end of the session. This account is enabled by default, to disable it, click
+in the menu on<guimenu> Actions -> Uninstall guest account</guimenu>.</para>
+</section> \ No newline at end of file